2016 RDX Owner`s Manual - Techinfo

2016 RDX Owner`s Manual - Techinfo
California Proposition 65 Warning
WARNING: This product contains or emits
chemicals known to the state of California to cause
cancer and birth defects or other reproductive
harm.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have the special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR.
Event Data Recorders
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
00X31-TX4-6310
Service Diagnostic Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance. The data can be used
to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians
diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with
data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains
confidential.
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention Act
The airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this
vehicle may contain perchlorate materials - special handling may
apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded
by a NOTICE symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
2016 RDX Owner's Manual - Ver.3
BOM02771
A Few Words About Safety
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
● Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol 3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgment.
3DANGER
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3WARNING
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3CAUTION
You CAN be HURT if you don't follow
instructions.
● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
● Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual (including the front cover)
represent features and equipment that are available on some, but
not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these
features.
This owner’s manual is for vehicles sold in the United States and
Canada.
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
2 Safe Driving P. 23
For Safe Driving P. 24
Seat Belts P. 29
Airbags P. 37
2 Instrument Panel P. 65
Indicators P. 66
Gauges and Multi-Information Display P. 93
2 Controls P. 117
Setting the Clock P. 118
Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 119
Opening and Closing the Moonroof P. 143
Adjusting the Seats P. 162
2 Features P. 185
Audio System * P. 186
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver P. 222
Audio System Basic Operation * P. 190
2 Driving P. 255
Before Driving P. 256
Towing a Trailer P. 261
Parking Your Vehicle P. 326 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 334
2 Maintenance P. 339
Before Performing Maintenance P. 340
Maintenance MinderTM P. 343
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 366
Climate Control System Maintenance P. 382
Cleaning P. 383
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 389
Tools P. 390
Overheating P. 414
If a Tire Goes Flat P. 391
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 416
2 Information P. 425
Specifications P. 426
Emissions Testing P. 431
Identification Numbers P. 428
Warranty Coverages P. 433
Contents
Quick Reference Guide
Child Safety P. 50
Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 62
Opening and Closing the Tailgate P. 131 Security System P. 137
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 144
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 169
Audio Error Messages * P. 215
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * P. 224
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 266
Refueling P. 335
Opening and Closing the Windows P. 140
Adjusting the Mirrors P. 159
Climate Control System P. 180
General Information on the Audio System * P. 218
Compass * P. 253
When Driving P. 268
Fuel Economy P. 337
Replacing Light Bulbs P. 359
Battery P. 379
Remote Transmitter Care P. 380
Engine Does Not Start P. 408
Fuses P. 420
Jump Starting P. 411
Emergency Towing P. 423
Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 413
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate P. 424
Reporting Safety Defects P. 430
Client Service Information P. 436
Safe Driving
P. 23
Instrument Panel
P. 65
Controls
P. 117
Features
P. 185
Driving
P. 255
Maintenance
P. 339
Handling the Unexpected
P. 389
Information
P. 425
Index
P. 437
Braking P. 314
Accessories and Modifications P. 338
Maintenance Under the Hood P. 347
Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 370
Devices that Emit Radio Waves P. 429
Authorized Manuals P. 435
P. 4
Safety Labels P. 63
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ System Indicators (P 66)
❙ Gauges (P 93)
❙ Multi-Information Display (P 94)
❙ Audio/Information Screen (P 191)
❙ Navigation System *
() See Navigation System Manual
❙ Hazard Warning Button
❙ Audio System * (P 186)
❙ On Demand Multi-Use DisplayTM*
() See Navigation System Manual
❙ ENGINE START/STOP Button (P 144)
❙ Rear Window Defogger (P 155)
❙ Heated Mirror Button (P 155)
❙ Climate Control System (P 180)
❙ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P 158)
❙ (Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®)
System OFF) Button (P 306)
❙ Lane Departure Warning (LDW)
Button * (P 294)
❙ Parking Sensor System Button* (P 328)
❙ Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) OFF Button * (P 321)
❙ Power Tailgate Button (P 135)
4
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Headlights/Turn Signals (P 147)
❙ Fog Lights * (P 150)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift down) (P 278)
❙ Horn (Press an area around
.)
❙ (SEL/RESET) Knob (P 154)
❙ Brightness Control (P 154)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift up) (P 278)
❙ Wipers/Washers (P 151)
❙ Cruise Control Buttons * (P 279)
❙ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Buttons *
(P 284)
❙ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Distance
Button * (P 289)
❙ Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Button * (P 299)
❙ SEL/RESET Button (P 94)
❙
(Information) Button (P 94)
❙ Navigation System Voice Control Buttons *
() See Navigation System Manual
❙ Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® System Voice
Control Buttons (P 224)
❙ MODE Button (P189)
❙ CH (Channel) Buttons (P189)
❙ VOL (Volume) Buttons (P189)
* Not available on all models
5
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Power Window Switches (P 140)
❙ Power Door Lock Master Switch (P 129)
❙ Door Mirror Controls (P 160)
❙ Memory Buttons (P 157)
❙ SET Button (P 157)
❙ Interior Fuse Box (P 421)
❙ Rearview Mirror (P 159)
❙ Driver’s Front Airbag (P 40)
❙ Passenger’s Front Airbag
(P 40)
❙ Shift Lever Automatic
Transmission (P 275)
❙ Glove Box (P 171)
❙ Seat Heater Switches (P 177)
❙ Parking Brake (P 314)
❙ Hood Release Handle (P 348)
❙ Fuel Fill Door Release Handle (P 336)
6
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Cargo Area Light (P 170)
❙ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor (P 34)
❙ Seat Belt (Installing a Child Seat) (P 57)
❙ Seat Belt to Secure a Child Seat (P 58)
❙ Side Curtain Airbags (P 46)
❙ Ceiling Light (P 169)
❙ Seat Belts (P 29)
❙ Moonroof Switch (P 143)
❙ Map Lights (P 169)
❙ Sunglasses Holder (P 176)
❙ Sun Visors
❙ Vanity Mirrors
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P 174)
❙ USB Port (P 187)
❙ Auxiliary Input Jack (P 187)
❙ Front Seat (P 162)
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P 174)
❙ Side Airbags (P 44)
❙ Coat Hook (P 175)
❙ Grab Handle
❙ Rear Seat (P 167)
❙ LATCH to Secure a Child Seat (P 55)
7
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Maintenance Under the Hood (P 347)
❙ Windshield Wipers (P 151, 366)
❙ Power Door Mirrors (P 160)
❙ Door Lock/Unlock Control (P 123)
❙ Headlights (P 147, 359)
❙ Front Turn Signal Lights/Parking Lights/
Daytime Running Lights (P 147, 361)
❙ Side Marker Lights (P 147, 361)
❙ Tires (P 370, 391)
❙ Fog Lights * (P 150, 359)
❙ How to Refuel (P 336)
❙ High-Mount Brake Light (P 365)
❙ Rear Wiper (P 153, 368)
❙ Opening/Closing the Tailgate
(P 131)
❙ Tailgate Release Button (P 132)
❙ Multi-View Rear Camera (P 334)
❙ Brake/Taillights (P 362)
❙ Back-Up Lights (P 364)
❙ Rear Turn Signal Lights (P 362)
❙ Rear Side Marker Lights (P 362)
8
Safe Driving
(P 23)
Child Safety (P 50)
● All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
● Smaller children should be properly restrained in a forward-facing child seat.
● Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child seat.
Quick Reference Guide
Airbags (P 37)
● Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P 62)
● Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain carbon
monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces where carbon
monoxide gas can accumulate.
Seat Belts (P 29)
Before Driving Checklist (P 28)
● Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
● Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
● Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints,
steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
* Not available on all models
9
Instrument Panel
(P 65)
Quick Reference Guide
Gauges (P 93)/Multi-Information Display (P 94)/System Indicators (P 66)
System Indicators
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
Charging System
Indicator
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Indicator */ CRUISE MAIN
Indicator *
System Indicators
Lane Keeping Assist System
(LKAS) Indicator */CRUISE
CONTROL Indicator *
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
with Intelligent Control
System Indicator*
Multi-Information Display
Speedometer
Tachometer
Temperature
Gauge
Turn Signal and Hazard
Warning Indicators
Fuel Gauge
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®) System
Indicator
Low Fuel Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator *
Immobilizer System
Indicator
U.S.
Parking Brake and
Brake System
Indicator (Red)
Canada
Shift Lever
Position
Indicator
Supplemental Restraint
System Indicator
Security System Alarm
Indicator
Models without
full color display
CRUISE MAIN Indicator *
(M (Sequential Shift mode)
Indicator/Gear Position
Indicator
CRUISE CONTROL
Indicator *
System Message
Indicator
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Keyless Access System
Indicator
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
Indicator *
Blind spot information
(BSI) System Indicator *
10
Lights Indicators
U.S.
Lights On Indicator
Canada
High Beam Indicator
Fog Light Indicator
Brake System
Indicator (Amber)
*
Collision Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) Indicator *
Controls
(P 117)
Models without navigation system
a
Press and hold the CLOCK (AUX)
button until Adjust Clock appears.
b
Press Preset (4 (Hour) or (5 (Minute)
to set the time.
c
ENGINE START/STOP
Button (P 144)
Lights (P 147)
Light Control Switches
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
High Beam
Low Beam
Press the CLOCK button again to set
the time.
Quick Reference Guide
Clock (P 118)
Flashing
To set the time to the nearest hour: Press
and hold the CLOCK button until Adjust
Clock appears, then press the (6 (Reset)
button.
Depending on the displayed time, the clock
sets forward or backward.
Example:
1:06 will reset to 1:00
1:53 will reset to 2:00
Turn Signals (P 147)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Right
Models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
Left
* Not available on all models
11
Wipers and Washers (P 151)
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
Quick Reference Guide
Adjustment Ring
: Low Sensitivity*1
: Lower speed, fewer sweeps*2
: High Sensitivity*1
: Higher speed, more sweeps*2
Pull toward
you to spray
washer fluid.
MIST
OFF
AUTO*1: Wiper speed varies automatically
INT*2: Low speed with intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
*1 : Models with automatic intermittent wipers
*2 : Models without automatic intermittent
wipers
Models with automatic intermittent wipers
AUTO should always be turned OFF before
cleaning the windshield or driving through a
car wash.
12
Steering Wheel (P 158)
Tailgate (P 131)
● To adjust, pull the adjustment lever
towards you, adjust to the desired
position, then lock the lever back in place.
Unlocking the Front Doors
from the Inside (P 128)
● Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it at the same time.
● Press the tailgate release button to
unlock and open the tailgate.
● Press the power tailgate button on the
instrument panel or the remote
transmitter to open and close the power
tailgate.
Power Windows (P 140)
● With the power mode in ON, open and
close the power windows.
● If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger’s window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
● If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator on), each
passenger’s window switch is disabled.
Selector Switch
Power Window Lock Button
Quick Reference Guide
Power Door Mirrors (P 160)
● With the power mode in ON, move the
selector switch to L or R.
● Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
● Place the selector switch in the L or R
position to use the reverse tilt door mirror
feature.
● Press the folding button * to fold in and
out the door mirrors.
Indicator
Folding Button *
Adjustment Switch
Window Switch
* Not available on all models
13
Climate Control System (P 180)
Quick Reference Guide
● Press the AUTO button to activate the climate control system.
● Press the
button to turn the system on or off.
● Press the
button to defrost the windshield.
Models with navigation system
The climate control system is voice operable. See the navigation system manual for complete details.
/
(On/Off) Button
(Fan Control) Buttons
(Windshield Defroster) Button
SYNC (Synchronized) Button
Passenger’s Side Temperature
Control Dial
Driver’s Side Temperature
Control Dial
AUTO Button
MODE Control Button
Air flows from dashboard
vents.
Air flows from floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from floor vents.
Air flows from floor and
windshield defroster vents.
14
(Recirculation) Button
A/C (Air Conditioning) Button
Features
● Audio Remote Controls (P 189)
VOL (Volume) Buttons
MODE Button
(P 185)
For navigation system operation () See Navigation System Manual
Audio/Information Screen
CH (Channel) Buttons
Button
VOL/
Knob
(CD Eject)
Button
(Power/volume)
CD Slot
CD Button
FM/AM Button
Preset Buttons
(1-6)
CATEGORY Bar
AUX Button
SCAN Button
A.SEL Button
SKIP Bar
PHONE Button
DISPLAY Button
BACK Button
SETUP Button
Quick Reference Guide
Audio System * (P 186)
● VOL (Volume) Button
Press and release to adjust the volume up/
down.
● MODE Button
Press and release to change the audio
mode: FM1/FM2/AM/SiriusXM®1/
SiriusXM®2/CD/AUX.
● CH (Channel) Button
Radio:Press and release to change the
preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
CD/USB device:
Press and release to skip to the
beginning of the next song or
return to the beginning of the
current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
Selector Knob
* Not available on all models
15
Driving
(P 255)
Quick Reference Guide
Automatic Transmission (P 275)
● Shift to (P and depress the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
● Shifting
Release Button
Shift Lever
Park
Turn off or start the engine.
Transmission is locked.
Paddle Shifters (P 277)
● Paddle shifters allow you to shift gears much like a manual transmission (1st
through 6th). This is useful for engine braking.
● D-paddle shift mode: The transmission will shift back to automatic mode once
the system detects that the vehicle is cruising.
● Sequential shift mode: Holds the selected gear, and the M indicator comes on.
Models without full color display
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Neutral
Transmission is not locked.
Selected Gear Number
M Indicator
● The selected gear
position is shown in
the instrument panel.
Depress the brake pedal and press the
release button to move out of (P .
Press the release button to
move the shift lever.
Move the shift lever without
pressing the release button.
16
Shift Lever
Position
Indicator
Shift Lever Position
Indicator
Drive
Normal driving. D-paddle shift mode can be used.
S Position
Sequential shift mode can be used.
Models with full color display
Shift Down (-)
Paddle Shifter
M Indicator
Selected Gear
Number
Shift Up (+)
Paddle Shifter
VSA® OFF Button (P 306)
Refueling (P 335)
Fuel recommendation: Unleaded premium gasoline with a pump octane
number 91 or higher recommended
Fuel tank capacity: 16 US gal (60.5 L)
a
Pull the fuel fill door
release handle.
b
Turn the fuel fill cap
slowly to remove the
cap.
c
Place the cap in the
holder on the fuel fill
door.
d
After refueling, screw
the cap back on until it
clicks at least once.
Cruise Control * (P 279)
● Cruise control allows you to maintain a
set speed without keeping your foot on
the accelerator pedal.
● To use cruise control, press the CRUISE
button, then press DECEL/SET once you
have achieved the desired speed (above
25 mph or 40 km/h).
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) (P 310)
Quick Reference Guide
● The vehicle stability assist (VSA®) system
helps stabilize the vehicle during
cornering, and helps maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
● VSA® comes on automatically every time
you start the engine.
● To turn VSA® on or off, press and hold
the button until you hear a beep.
● TPMS monitors tire pressure.
● TPMS is turned on automatically every
time you start the engine.
* Not available on all models
17
Maintenance
Quick Reference Guide
Under the Hood (P 347)
● Check engine oil, engine coolant, and windshield washer
fluid. Add when necessary.
● Check brake fluid.
● Check the battery condition monthly.
a
Pull the hood release handle under the corner of the
dashboard.
b
Locate the hood latch lever, slide the lever, and lift up the
hood.
c
18
(P 339)
When finished, close the hood and make sure it is firmly
locked in place.
Wiper Blades (P 366)
● Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windshield.
Tires (P 370)
Lights (P 359)
● Inspect tires and wheels regularly.
● Check tire pressures regularly.
● Install snow tires for winter
driving.
● Inspect all lights regularly.
Handling the Unexpected
(P 389)
Engine Won’t Start (P 408)
Overheating (P 414)
Vehicles with tire repair kit
● If the battery is dead, jump start using a
booster battery.
● Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the hood, open the hood,
and let the engine cool down.
● Park in a safe location and repair the flat
tire using the tire repair kit.
Vehicles with a compact spare tire
● Park in a safe location and replace the
flat tire with the compact spare tire in the
cargo area.
Indicators Come On (P 416)
Blown Fuse (P 420)
Emergency Towing (P 423)
● Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
● Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
Quick Reference Guide
Flat Tire (P 391)
● Identify the indicator and consult the
owner’s manual.
19
What to Do If
Quick Reference Guide
20
The power mode does not
change from VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) to ACCESSORY.
Why?
●
The power mode does not
change from ACCESSORY
to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Why?
The shift lever should be moved to (P .
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
This can occur when the ABS activates, and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
●
The steering wheel may be locked.
Move the steering wheel left and right
after pressing the ENGINE START/STOP
button.
Check if the childproof lock is in the
lock position. If so, open the rear
door with the outside door handle.
To cancel this function, push the
lever to the unlock position.
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors
using a remote
transmitter?
If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver’s door?
The beeper sounds when:
● The exterior lights are left on.
● The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
The beeper sounds when:
● Driver and/or front passenger are not wearing their seat belts.
● The parking brake lever is not fully released.
Quick Reference Guide
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
21
Quick Reference Guide
22
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Is it possible to use
unleaded gasoline with a
Pump Octane Number
(PON) of 87 or higher on
this vehicle?
Unleaded gasoline with a Pump Octane Number (PON) of 91 or
higher is recommended.
Use of lower octane gasoline can cause occasional metallic
knocking noise in the engine and will result in decreased engine
performance.
Use of gasoline with a pump octane less than 87 can lead to
engine damage.
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions ............. 24
Important Handling Information......... 26
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features............ 27
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts........................ 29
Fastening a Seat Belt.......................... 32
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 36
Airbags
Airbag System Components............... 37
Types of Airbags ................................ 40
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 40
Side Airbags ...................................... 44
Side Curtain Airbags .......................... 46
Airbag System Indicators.................... 47
Airbag Care ....................................... 49
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 50
Safety of Infants and Small Children .......52
Safety of Larger Children ................... 60
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas....................... 62
Safety Labels
Label Locations .................................. 63
23
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle’s safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions
■ Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
■ Restrain all children
Children age 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger
children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the
belt properly without a booster seat.
■ Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
■ Don’t drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don’t drink and drive, and don’t let your friends drink and drive, either.
24
1Important Safety Precautions
Some states, provinces and territories prohibit the use
of cell phones other than hands-free devices by the
driver while driving.
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
■ Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
■ Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Safe Driving
Engaging in cell phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
■ Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
25
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Handling Information
Important Handling Information
Safe Driving
26
Your vehicle has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use
only on pavement. Higher ground clearance has many advantages for off-highway
driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also
provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher
off the ground, it has a higher center gravity making it more susceptible to tripping
or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder,
make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
1Important Handling Information
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover,
read:
2 Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
P. 273
2 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 266
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
1Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
9
8
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat
belts in a sufficient crash.
6
10
7
8
10
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
11
7
6
7
8
9
10
11
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
9
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Door Locks
Seat Belt Tensioners
The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
Continued
27
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
■ Safety Checklist
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
• After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure all doors and the tailgate are
closed and locked. Locking the doors and the tailgate helps prevent an occupant
from being ejected and an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door or the
tailgate.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 128
• Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
1Safety Checklist
If the door and tailgate open indicator * is on and a
message appears on the multi-information display, a
door and/or the tailgate is not completely closed.
Close all doors and the tailgate tightly until the
message disappears.
2 Door and Tailgate Open Indicator * P. 72
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 87
*
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 162
• Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the center of the head restraint aligns with the center of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 164
• Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 32
• Protect children by using seat belts or child seats according to a child’s age, height
and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 50
28
* Not available on all models
Models with
full color display
Models without
full color display
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
In addition, seat belts help protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
■ Lap/shoulder seat belts
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body. The front passenger’s and rear seat belts also have a lockable
retractor for use with child seats.
2 Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt P. 57
Continued
1About Your Seat Belts
3 WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Safe Driving
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against other passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most states and all Canadian provinces and territories
require you to wear seat belts.
The emergency locking retractor may lock if you lean
forward too quickly. Slower movements will allow
the belt to extend fully without locking.
29
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Proper use of seat belts
1About Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
• All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduces the effectiveness of
the belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
• Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
• Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
■ Seat Belt Reminder
1Seat Belt Reminder
Your vehicle monitors front seat belt use. If
the power mode is set to ON before the
driver’s seat belt is fastened, a beeper will
sound and the indicator will blink. If the driver
does not fasten the belt before the beeper
stops, the indicator will remain on.
Models with
full color
display
30
Models
without full
color display
If a rear seat passenger moves around and extends
the seat belt, the lockable retractor may activate. If
this happens, release the retractor by unfastening the
seat belt and allow the belt to retract completely.
Then refasten the belt.
The beeper will also periodically sound and
the indicator will blink while driving until the
driver’s and front passenger’s seat belts are
fastened.
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within 6 seconds after
the power mode is set to ON.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger’s seat,
or a child or small adult is riding there, the indicator
will not come on.
This is because the weight sensors in the seat cannot
detect their presence.
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The front seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
Safe Driving
The tensioners automatically tighten the front seat belts during a moderate-tosevere frontal collision, sometimes even if the collision is not severe enough to
inflate the front airbags.
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
31
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 162
Safe Driving
Pull out slowly.
Correct
Seated
Posture.
Buckle
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
Latch
Plate
32
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
1Fastening a Seat Belt
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
Safe Driving
Lap belt
as low as
possible
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the center of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button then
guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is out of
the way and will not get caught by closing the door.
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
holding the release button.
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
across the center of your chest and over
Push
your shoulder.
Continued
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
33
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
1. Pull out the seat belt’s small latch plate and
the latch plate from each holding slot in the
ceiling.
Small Latch Plate
1Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
3 WARNING
Safe Driving
Using the seat belt with the detachable
anchor unlatched increases the chance of
serious injury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the
detachable anchor is correctly latched.
Latch Plate
Small Latch Plate
2. Line up the triangle marks on the small
latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure
the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt
to the anchor buckle.
To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch
plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
Latch Plate
Anchor Buckle
Latch
Plate
Buckle
34
3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle.
Properly fasten the seat belt the same way
you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.
Small Latch Plate
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
• When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
• When sitting in the front passenger’s seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
35
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
Safe Driving
• Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
• Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
36
1Seat Belt Inspection
3 WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
Airbags
Airbag System Components
10
9
8
Safe Driving
8
7
11
6
8
8
8
8
Continued
37
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. Both side
curtain airbags are deployed in a rollover.
The airbag system includes:
d An electronic control unit that continually
monitors and can records information
about the sensors, the airbag activators,
the seat belt tensioners, and driver and
front passenger seat belt use when the
power mode is in ON.
sensors that can detect a
moderate to severe front or side impact.
i An indicator on the dashboard that alerts
you that the front passenger’s front
airbag has been turned off.
a Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver’s airbag is stored
in the center of the steering wheel; the
front passenger’s airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
e Automatic
front seat belt tensioners. The
driver’s and front passenger’s seat belts
incorporate sensors that detect whether
or not they are fastened.
b Two
side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
c Two
side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
j An indicator on the instrument panel that
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
kA
fA
38
h Impact
driver’s seat position sensor. If the seat
is too far forward, the airbag will inflate
with less force.
g Weight
sensors in the front passenger’s
seat. The front passenger’s airbag will be
turned off if the weight on the seat is 65
lbs (29 kg) or less (the weight of an infant
or small child).
rollover sensor that detects whether
the vehicle is about to roll over.
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
■ Important Facts About Your Airbags
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, and sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not
wearing their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
1Important Facts About Your Airbags
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
39
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Types of Airbags
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
• Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver’s and front passenger’s seats.
• Side airbags: Airbags in the driver’s and front passenger’s seat-backs.
• Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
Front Airbags (SRS)
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help protect
the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant’s primary
restraint system.
■ Housing Locations
The front airbags are housed in the center of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
40
1Types of Airbags
The airbags can inflate whenever the power mode is
in ON.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not harmful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
1Front Airbags (SRS)
Dual-Stage, Multiple-Threshold Front Airbags
(SRS)
Your vehicle is equipped with dual-stage, multiplethreshold front airbags (SRS).
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, the airbags can inflate
at different rates, depending on the severity of the
crash, whether or not the seat belts are latched, and/
or other factors. Frontal airbags are designed to
supplement the seat belts to help reduce the
likelihood of head and chest injuries in frontal
crashes.
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Operation
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
■ How the Front Airbags Work
1How the Front Airbags Work
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won’t interfere with the driver’s visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
Although the driver’s and front passenger’s airbags
normally inflate within a split second of each other, it
is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can
happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin,
or threshold, that determines whether or not the
airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will
provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental
protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
Continued
41
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ When front airbags should not deploy
Safe Driving
42
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur
during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move towards the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help reduce the
severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move towards the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: Seat belts and, in vehicles equipped with a rollover sensor, side airbags
and side curtain airbags offer the best protection in a rollover. Because front airbags
could provide little if any protection, they are not designed to deploy during a
rollover.
■ When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Advanced Airbags
1Advanced Airbags
Driver’s
Seat
Position
Sensor
If the seat is too far forward, the airbag
inflates with less force, regardless of the
severity of the impact.
The passenger’s advanced front airbag system
has weight sensors.
Passenger’s
Seat
Weight
Sensors
If there is a problem with the driver’s seat position
sensor, the SRS indicator will come on and the airbag
will inflate with full (normal) force, regardless of the
driver’s seating position.
For both advanced front airbags to work properly:
• Do not spill any liquid on or under the seats.
• Do not put any object under the passenger’s seat.
• Make sure any objects are positioned properly on
the floor. Improperly positioned objects can
interfere with the advanced airbag sensors.
• All occupants should sit upright and wear their seat
belts properly.
• Do not place any cover over the passenger side
dashboard.
Safe Driving
Your front airbags have advanced features to help reduce the likelihood of airbag
related injuries to smaller occupants.
The driver’s advanced front airbag system
includes a seat position sensor.
Although Acura recommends against carrying
an infant or small child in front, if the sensors
detect the weight of a child (up to about 65
lbs or 29 kg), the system will automatically
turn off the passenger’s front airbag.
43
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Side Airbags
The side airbags help protect the upper torso of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
Safe Driving
■ Housing Locations
The side airbags are housed in the outside
edge of the driver’s and passenger’s seatbacks.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
Housing
Location
■ Operation
When
inflated
Side
Airbag
44
When the sensors detect a moderate-tosevere side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
1Side Airbags
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer.
Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back
covers can prevent your side airbags from properly
deploying during a side impact.
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
■ When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag to not deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was towards
the far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle’s crushable body parts
absorbed most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have
been needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
Safe Driving
Because the airbag system senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle’s framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
45
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Safe Driving
Side curtain airbags help protect the heads of the driver and passengers in outer
seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact. The side curtain airbags
equipped in this vehicle are also designed to help reduce the likelihood of partial and
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side windows in crashes, particularly
rollover crashes.
■ Housing Locations
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
1Side Curtain Airbags
If the SRS control unit senses that your vehicle is
about to rollover, it immediately deploys both side
curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt
tensioners.
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the
passenger’s side curtain airbag will inflate even if
there are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
To get the best protection from the side curtain
airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts
properly and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
■ Operation
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a rollover or a moderate-to-severe side
impact.
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
46
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
Safe Driving
One or both side curtain airbags may inflate in a moderate to severe angled frontal
collision.
In this case, the side curtain airbags will deploy slightly after the front airbags.
Airbag System Indicators
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on and a
message appears on the multi-information display.
■ SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Indicator
Models with
full color
display
1SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) Indicator
■ When the power mode is set to ON
3 WARNING
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
Models
without full
color display
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, have the
system checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you don’t, your airbags and seat
belt tensioners may not work properly when they are needed.
Continued
47
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
U.S.
Canada
■ When the passenger airbag off
Safe Driving
indicator comes on
The indicator comes on to alert you that the
passenger’s front airbag has been turned off.
This occurs when the front passenger’s weight
sensors detect 65 lbs (29 kg) or less, the
weight of an infant or small child, on the seat.
1Passenger Airbag Off Indicator
If the indicator comes on with no front passenger and
no objects on the passenger’s seat, or with an adult
riding there, something may be interfering with the
weight sensors. Such as:
• An object hanging on the seat or in the seat-back
pocket.
• A child seat or other object pressing against the
rear of the seat-back.
• A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of
the front passenger’s seat.
• The front seat or seat-back is forced back against
Infants and small children should always ride properly restrained in a back seat.
2 Child Safety P. 50
48
an object on the seat or floor behind it.
• An object placed under the front passenger’s seat.
Objects placed on the seat can also cause the indicator to come on.
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
If the front passenger seat is empty, the passenger’s front airbag will not deploy and
the indicator will not come on.
The passenger airbag off indicator may come on and
goes off repeatedly if the total weight on the seat is
near the airbag cutoff threshold.
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
Safe Driving
■ When the airbags have deployed
1Airbag Care
■ When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: the driver’s
seat position sensor, weight sensors in the passenger’s seat, front seat belt
tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
■ Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting a dealer
This would likely disable the driver’s seat position sensor or the weight sensors in the
passenger’s seat. If it is necessary to remove or modify a front seat to accommodate
a person with disabilities, contact an Acura dealer. For U.S. vehicles, Acura Client
Service at 800-382-2238 and for Canadian vehicles, Acura Client Service at
1-888-9-ACURA-9.
49
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
Safe Driving
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state, Canadian province
and territory requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride
in a vehicle.
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
• An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
• A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver’s ability to safely
control the vehicle.
• Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
50
1Protecting Child Passengers
3 WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in a child seat. A larger
child should be properly restrained with a
seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that all children
ages 12 and under be properly restrained in a rear
seat. Some states or provinces/territories have laws
restricting where children may ride.
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
• Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt correctly must be restrained in an
approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle using either the lap belt
portion of the lap/shoulder belt or the lower anchors of the LATCH system.
• Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
• Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
• Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
3 WARNING
Allowing a child to play with a seat belt or
wrap one around their neck can result in
serious injury or death.
Instruct children not to play with any seat
belt and make sure any unused seat belt a
child can reach is buckled, fully retracted,
and locked.
Safe Driving
• Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
1Protecting Child Passengers
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle warning came
with a label on the dashboard (U.S. models) and has
labels on the front visors. Please read and follow the
instructions on these labels.
2 Safety Labels P. 63
51
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Infants
Safe Driving
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the
infant reaches the seat manufacturer’s weight or height limit for the seat, and the
infant is at least one year old.
■ Positioning a rear-facing child seat
Child seats must be placed and secured in a
rear seating position.
1Protecting Infants
3 WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front
seat can result in serious injury or death
during a crash.
Always place a rear-facing child seat in the
rear seat, not the front.
Rear-facing child seats should never be installed in a
forward facing position.
Always refer to the child seat manufacturer’s
instructions before installation.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front
passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back
in the desired position.
It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger’s advanced front airbag
system.
2 Airbags P. 37
If this occurs, we recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front
passenger’s seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied.
Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
52
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Smaller Children
1Protecting Smaller Children
3 WARNING
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the
front seat can result in serious injury or
death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child
seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, and properly restrain the
child.
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and within the weight range indicated by the child
seat manufacturer, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly secured
forward-facing child seat.
■ Forward-facing child seat placement
We strongly recommend placing a forwardfacing child seat in a rear seating position.
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child seat use where you are driving, and
follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can be hazardous, even with
advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
Continued
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing seat
up to age two, if the child’s height and weight are
appropriate for a rear-facing seat.
53
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Selecting a Child Seat
Safe Driving
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren).
Some have a rigid-type connector, while others have a flexible-type connector. Both
are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child seats can only be
installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child seat
manufacturer’s use and care instructions as well as the instructions in this manual.
Proper installation is key to maximizing your child’s safety.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCH compatible
child seat can be installed using the seat belt and a top tether for added security.
This is because all child seats are required to be designed so that they can be secured
with a lap belt or the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. In addition, the child seat
manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat
once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child seat owner’s manual
for proper installation instructions.
■ Important consideration when selecting a child seat
Make sure the child seat meets the following three requirements:
• The child seat is the correct type and size for the child.
• The child seat is the correct type for the seating position.
• The child seat is compliant with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
54
1Selecting a Child Seat
Installation of a LATCH-compatible child seat is
simple.
LATCH-compatible child seats have been developed
to simplify the installation process and reduce the
likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Safe Driving
A LATCH-compatible child seat can be installed in either of the two outer rear seats.
A child seat is attached to the lower anchors with either the rigid or flexible type of
connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchors under the marks.
Marks
Lower Anchors
Rigid Type
2. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat then
attach the child seat to the lower anchors
according to the instructions that came
with the child seat.
u When installing the child seat, make sure
that the lower anchors are not
obstructed by the seat belt or any other
object.
Continued
55
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Safe Driving
For your child’s safety, when using a child seat
installed using the LATCH system, make sure that the
seat is properly secured to the vehicle. A child seat
that is not properly secured will not adequately
protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the
child or other vehicle occupants.
Flexible Type
Tether
Strap
Hook
Anchor
3. Put the head restraint to its upper-most
position, then route the tether strap
between the head restraint legs, and secure
the tether strap hook onto the anchor.
4. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
5. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
6. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 50
56
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
A child seat that is not properly secured will not
adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause
injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
Safe Driving
1. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat.
2. Route the seat belt through the child seat
according to the seat manufacturer’s
instructions, and insert the latch plate into
the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
3. Slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all
the way out until it stops. This activates the
lockable retractor.
4. Let the seat belt completely wind up into
the retractor, then try to pull it out to make
sure the retractor is locked.
u If you are able to pull the shoulder belt
out, the lockable retractor is not
activated. Pull the seat belt all the way
out, and repeat steps 3 – 4.
5. Grab the shoulder part of the seat belt near
the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack
from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
the child seat and push it into the vehicle
seat.
Continued
57
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
6. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
7. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 50
■ Adding Security with a Tether
Anchor
Tether Anchorage Points
58
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
Two tether anchorage points are provided
behind the rear outer seating positions and
one in the ceiling for the rear center. A child
seat that is installed with a seat belt and
comes with a tether can use the tether for
additional security.
1Adding Security with a Tether
Since a tether can provide additional security to the
lap/shoulder seat belt installation, we recommend
using a tether whenever one is available.
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Tether
Strap
Hook
Anchor
Tether Strap
Hook
1. Put the head restraint to its upper-most
position, then route the tether strap
through the head restraint legs. Make sure
the strap is not twisted.
2. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
3. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
Safe Driving
Anchor
■ Using an outer anchor
■ Using the center anchor
1. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
2. Open the anchor cover.
3. Route the tether strap over the head
restraint. Make sure the strap is not twisted.
4. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
59
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children
Safe Driving
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
■ Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child is too big for a child seat, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/
shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the
following questions.
■ Checklist
• Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
• Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child’s neck and arm?
• Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child’s thighs?
• Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
60
1Safety of Larger Children
3 WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger’s front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
a rear seating position. For the child’s safety,
check that the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer’s recommendations.
Some U.S. states and Canadian provinces and
territories require children to use a booster seat until
they reach a given age or weight (e.g. 6 years or 60
lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the state or
province, or territory where you intend to drive.
■ Protecting Larger Children-Final Checks
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
• Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
• Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
• Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
• Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
■ Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
61
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colorless,
odorless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon
monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
Safe Driving
■ Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
• The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
• The exhaust system may have been damaged.
• The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate
open, open all the windows and set the climate control system as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the
mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
Adjust the climate control system in the same manner if you sit in your parked
vehicle with the engine running.
62
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not run the engine with the garage door closed.
Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the
garage immediately after starting the engine.
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
Sun Visor
U.S. models
Dashboard
U.S. models only
Canadian models
Safe Driving
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact a dealer
for a replacement.
Sun Visor
U.S. models only
Radiator Cap
63
64
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 66
Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages...................... 82
Gauges and Multi-Information Display
Gauges.............................................. 93
Multi-Information Display .................. 94
65
Indicators
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
U.S.
Instrument Panel
●
Canada
Parking Brake
and Brake
System Indicator
(Red)
●
●
(Red)
●
●
U.S.
●
Canada
Brake System
Indicator
(Amber)
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes
off if the parking brake has been
released.
Comes on when the parking brake is
applied, and goes off when it is
released.
Comes on when the brake fluid level is
low.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the brake system.
The beeper sounds and the indicator
comes on if you drive with the parking
brake not fully released.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes
off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
hydraulic brake boost system.
●
Message*1
Comes on while driving Make sure the parking brake is
released. Check the brake fluid
level.
2 What to do when the
indicator comes on while
driving P. 418
●
Comes on along with the ABS
indicator - Have the vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 If the Brake System
Indicator (Red) Comes On
P. 418
Stays on constantly - Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer.
U.S.
Canada
—
(Amber)
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
66
U.S.
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
●
●
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
●
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off when the
engine starts.
Comes on when the engine oil
pressure is low.
●
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off either when
the engine starts or after several
seconds if the engine does not start. If
“readiness codes” have not been set,
it blinks five times before it goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the emissions control system.
Blinks when a misfire in the engine’s
cylinders is detected.
●
Message*1
Comes on while driving Immediately stop in a safe place.
2 If the Low Oil Pressure
Indicator Comes On P. 416
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
Readiness codes are part of the
on board diagnostics for the
emissions control systems.
2 Testing of Readiness Codes
P. 431
●
●
Comes on while driving - Have
the vehicle checked by a dealer.
Blinks while driving - Stop in a
safe place where there are no
flammable objects. Stop the
engine for 10 minutes or more,
and wait for it to cool down.
Then, take the vehicle to a dealer.
2 If the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp Comes On or Blinks
P. 417
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
67
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Charging System
Indicator
●
Instrument Panel
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off when the
engine starts.
Comes on when the battery is not
charging.
●
Message*1
Comes on while driving - Turn
off the climate control system and
rear defogger in order to reduce
electricity consumption.
2 If the Charging System
Indicator Comes On P. 416
*2
Shift Lever
Position
Indicator
*3
*2
*2
*3
●
Indicates current shift lever position.
●
Blinks if the transmission system has a
problem.
●
Comes on when the manual
sequential shift mode is applied.
Transmission
Indicator
*3
M (sequential
shift mode)
Indicator/Gear
Position
Indicator
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
*2:Models with full color display
*3:Models without full color display
68
Explanation
2 Shifting P. 275
●
—
—
—
—
Blinks while driving - Avoid
sudden starts and acceleration
and have the vehicle checked by a
dealer immediately.
2 Sequential Shift Mode P. 277
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
Low Fuel
Indicator
●
●
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
●
Comes on and the beeper sounds if
you are not wearing a seat belt when
you set the power mode to ON.
If the front passenger is not wearing a
seat belt, the indicator comes on
about a few seconds later.
Blinks while driving if either you or the
front passenger has not fastened a
seat belt. The beeper sounds and the
indicator blinks at regular intervals.
●
Comes on when the fuel reserve is
running low (approximately 2.5 U.S.
gal./9.2 Liter left).
Blinks if there is a problem with the
fuel gauge.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes
off.
If it comes on at any other time, there
is a problem with the ABS.
●
●
Message*1
The beeper stops and the
indicator goes off when you and
the front passenger fasten their
seat belts.
Stays on after you or the front
passenger has fastened the
seat belt - A detection error may
have occurred in the sensor. Have
the vehicle checked by a dealer.
Instrument Panel
Seat Belt
Reminder
Indicator
Explanation
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 30
●
Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as
soon as possible.
Blinks - Have the vehicle checked
by a dealer.
Stays on constantly - Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer. With
this indicator on, your vehicle still
has normal braking ability but no
anti-lock function.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 316
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
69
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
●
●
●
All-Wheel Drive
(AWD) with
Intelligent
Control System
Indicator *
●
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if a problem with any of
the following is detected:
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
●
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have the vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the AWD with intelligent control
system.
Blinks when the AWD with
intelligent control system is
overheated. The system is inactive.
●
Stays on constantly - the engine
drives only the front wheels in this
state. Have the vehicle checked by a
dealer.
Blinks while driving - the engine
drives only the front wheels in this
state. Stop in a safe place, shift to (P ,
and idle the engine until the indicator
goes off. If the indicator does not
stop blinking, take your vehicle to a
dealer.
●
2 All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with
Intelligent Control System *
P. 310
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
70
* Not available on all models
Message*1
—
—
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®)
OFF Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate
VSA®.
●
Message*1
Stays on constantly - Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®),
aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System P. 305
2 VSA® On and Off P. 306
Instrument Panel
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA®)
System Indicator
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Blinks when VSA® is active.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the VSA® system or hill start assist
system.
Explanation
—
—
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
71
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Instrument Panel
*2
●
Door and
Tailgate Open
Indicator *
Comes on for a few seconds if you
set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on if any door or the tailgate
is not completely closed.
The beeper sounds and the indicator
comes on if any door or the tailgate
is opened while driving.
Explanation
●
Goes off when all doors and the
tailgate are closed.
Message*1
—
—
—
●
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System
Indicator
●
Comes on when you set the power
mode to ON, and goes off when the
engine starts.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
*2:Models without full color display
72
* Not available on all models
●
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have the vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator Comes
On P. 418
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
High Beam
Indicator
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON.
Comes on if the tire pressure of any
of the tires becomes significantly
low.
Blinks for about one minute, and
then stays on if there is a problem
with the TPMS, or when a compact
spare tire is temporarily installed.
●
The turn signal indicators blink when
you operate the turn signal lever.
If you press the hazard warning
button, both indicators and all turn
signals blink at the same time.
●
Comes on when the high beam
headlights are on.
●
Message*1
Comes on while driving - Stop in a
safe place, check tire pressures, and
inflate the tire(s) if necessary.
Blinks and remains on - Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer. If the
vehicle is fitted with a compact spare,
get your regular tire repaired or
replaced and put back on your vehicle
as soon as you can.
Instrument Panel
Low Tire
Pressure/TPMS
Indicator
Explanation
Does not blink or blinks rapidly A turn signal light bulb has blown.
Change the bulb immediately.
2 Front Turn Signal Light/Parking
Light/Daytime Running Light
and Front Side Marker Light
Bulbs P. 361
—
—
—
—
—
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
73
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Lights On
Indicator
Instrument Panel
Fog Light
Indicator *
●
●
●
Immobilizer
System Indicator
Comes on whenever the light
switch is on, or in AUTO when the
exterior lights are on.
Explanation
●
Comes on when the fog lights are
on.
Comes on briefly when you set the
power mode to ON, then goes off.
Comes on if the immobilizer system
cannot recognize the key
information.
—
●
●
●
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
74
* Not available on all models
If you set the power mode to
ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds
when the driver’s door is opened.
Blinks - You cannot start the engine.
Set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK), then select the ON mode
again.
Repeatedly blinks - The system may
be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems can occur.
Message*1
—
—
—
—
—
—
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Security System
Alarm Indicator
●
System
Message
Indicator
Blinks when the security system
alarm has been set.
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on along with a beep when
a problem is detected. A system
message on the multi-information
display appears at the same time.
●
●
●
Message*1
2 Security System Alarm P. 137
—
—
While the indicator is on, press the
/
(information) button to see
the message again.
Refer to the Indicators information in
this chapter when a system message
appears on the multi-information
display. Take the appropriate action for
the message.
The multi-information display does not
return to the normal screen unless the
warning is canceled, or the
/
button is pressed.
—
—
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
75
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
●
*2
*3
Instrument Panel
*2
*3
On/Blinking
CRUISE MAIN
Indicator *
CRUISE
CONTROL
Indicator *
●
●
Keyless Access
System Indicator
●
Comes on when you press the
CRUISE button.
Comes on if you have set a speed
for cruise control.
Comes on for a few seconds when
you change the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on as soon as a problem is
detected in the keyless access
system or keyless starting system.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
*2:Models with full color display
*3:Models without full color display
76
* Not available on all models
Explanation
●
Message *1
2 Cruise Control* P. 279
—
—
2 Cruise Control* P. 279
—
—
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you change the power mode to
ON, then goes off.
Stays on while BSI is turned off.
Message*1
—
Comes on when mud, snow, or ice
accumulates in the vicinity of
sensor.
●
Comes on if there is a problem with
the system.
●
Instrument Panel
Blind spot
information (BSI)
System
Indicator *
Explanation
Comes on while driving - Remove
the obstacle in the vicinity of sensor.
2 Blind spot information (BSI)
System * P. 307
Comes on while driving - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
* Not available on all models
Continued
77
uuIndicatorsu
Models with LDW
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
●
●
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds when
you change the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the LDW system.
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Comes on when the LDW system
shuts itself off.
●
Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool down
the camera.
The system activates when the temperature
inside the camera cools down.
Lane Departure
Warning (LDW)
Indicator
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
●
●
Stays on - The area around the camera is
blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle
in a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft
cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the
indicator and message come back on after
you cleaned the area around the camera.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
78
* Not available on all models
Message
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC)
Indicator (Amber) *
Lane Keeping
Assist System
(LKAS) Indicator
(Amber) *
Lane Keeping
Assist System
(LKAS) Indicator
(Green) *
* Not available on all models
●
●
●
●
●
Comes on when you press the MAIN
button.
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the LKAS.
Comes on when you press the MAIN
button.
Comes on while driving - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) * P. 284
●
Message
—
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
P. 297
Instrument Panel
Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC)
Indicator (Green) *
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with
ACC.
Explanation
—
Continued
79
uuIndicatorsu
Models with CMBSTM
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
80
Collision
Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator
* Not available on all models
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you change the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate the
CMBSTM. A multi-information display
message appears for five seconds.
Comes on if there is a problem with
the CMBSTM.
Explanation
●
Stays on constantly without the
CMBSTM off - Have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) * P. 318
Message
uuIndicatorsu
Models with CMBSTM
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Comes on when the CMBSTM system
shuts itself off.
Explanation
●
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
●
Collision
Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator
●
When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe off dirt
using a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the
message does not disappear even after you
clean the sensor cover.
Instrument Panel
Stays on - The area around the camera is
blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle
in a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft
cloth.
Message
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) * P. 318
●
Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high. Use the climate control
system to cool down the camera. The
system activates when the temperature
inside the camera cools down.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
* Not available on all models
81
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
The following messages appear only on the multi-information display. Press the
with the system message indicator on.
Message*1
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
Appears when the fuel fill cap is loose or is
not installed.
2 Tighten Fuel Cap Message P. 417
Appears when the washer fluid is low.
●
—
Refill washer fluid.
2 Refilling Window Washer Fluid P. 358
●
●
Appears while you are customizing the
settings and the shift lever is moved out of
(P .
Appears when the transmission fluid
temperature is too high.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
82
(information) button to see the message again
Condition
●
Canadian models
/
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
●
Stop in a safe place in (P . Let the engine
idle until the message disappears.
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message*1
Condition
●
●
U.S.
U.S.
●
Appears when the scheduled maintenance is
due soon.
Consequently, SERVICE DUE NOW/
Maintenance Due Soon and SERVICE PAST
DUE/Maintenance Past Due follow.
2 Maintenance Minder Messages on the
Multi-Information Display P. 344
Appears when the engine coolant
temperature gets abnormally high.
Appears when there is a problem with the
power tailgate system.
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 Overheating P. 414
●
●
Manually open or close the power tailgate.
Have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
Canada
—
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
83
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message*1
U.S.
Condition
U.S.
Instrument Panel
●
Appears if there is a problem with the starting
system.
●
Appears after you unlock and open the
driver’s door.
●
As a temporary measure, press and hold the
ENGINE START/STOP button for 15
seconds while depressing the brake pedal
and manually start the engine.
Have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
Canada
—
●
●
2 Starting the Engine P. 268
Appears three seconds after the TO START
ENGINE/To Start Engine message appears.
Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
84
Explanation
2 Starting the Engine P. 268
●
Move the steering wheel left and right after
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button.
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message*1
Condition
Appears if you press the ENGINE START/
STOP button to turn the engine off without
the shift lever in (P .
●
Appears when the power mode is in
ACCESSORY.
●
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice
after moving the shift lever to (P .
—
●
Appears after the driver’s door is opened
when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
●
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice
with your foot off the brake pedal to change
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
●
Appears when you close the door with the
power mode in ON without the keyless access
remote inside the vehicle.
●
The message goes off when you bring the
keyless access remote back inside the vehicle,
and close the door.
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 Keyless Access Remote Reminder P. 146
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
85
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message*1
Condition
●
Instrument Panel
86
●
Appears when the keyless access remote
battery becomes weak.
Appears if the keyless access remote’s battery
is too weak to start the engine or the key is
not with you when starting the engine. A
beeper sounds six times.
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Explanation
●
Replace the battery as soon as possible.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 380
2 If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is
Weak P. 409
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message*1
Condition
●
—
●
Explanation
●
Goes off when all doors and the tailgate are
closed.
Appears when there is a problem with the
headlights.
●
Appears while driving - The low beam
headlights may not be on. When conditions
allow you to drive safely, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Instrument Panel
Appears if any door or the tailgate is not
completely closed.
The beeper sounds and the message appears
if any door or the tailgate is opened while
driving.
—
—
●
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
Continued
87
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with parking sensor system
Message
Instrument Panel
88
Condition
Explanation
●
Appears if there is a problem with the parking sensor
system.
●
Check if the area around the sensor(s) is covered with
mud, ice, snow, etc. If the indicator(s) stays on even
after you clean the area, have the system checked by a
dealer.
●
Appears if there are obstacles around the sensors.
●
Check for obstacles near your vehicle to make sure it is
safe to park.
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with ACC
Message
Condition
●
Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with a
vehicle in front of you.
Explanation
●
Take the appropriate means to prevent a collision (apply
the brakes, change lanes, etc.).
●
Appears when ACC has been automatically canceled.
●
You can resume the set speed after the condition that
caused ACC to cancel improves. Press the RES/ACCEL
button.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) * P. 284
●
●
Appears if anything covers the radar sensor cover and
prevents the sensor from detecting a vehicle in front.
May appear when driving in bad weather (rain, snow,
fog, etc.).
* Not available on all models
●
●
Instrument Panel
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
P. 318
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) * P. 284
When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop your vehicle in a
safe place, and wipe off dirt using a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
does not disappear even after you clean the sensor cover.
Continued
89
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with two-way keyless access remote
Message*1
Condition
●
Appears when you unlock and open the driver’s
door while the engine is running by two-way
keyless access remote.
Instrument Panel
2 Remote Engine Start with Vehicle Feedback *
P. 270
*1:On the left: Models without full color display
On the right: Models with full color display
90
Explanation
* Not available on all models
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with LKAS
Message
Condition
Explanation
●
●
Keep the vehicle within the lane you are driving.
The color of either line changes from white to amber as
the vehicle gets closer to that side of the lane line.
●
Blinks when you fail to steer the vehicle. The beeper
sounds simultaneously.
●
Operate the steering wheel to resume the LKAS.
●
Appears when the LKAS is in operation, or the LKAS
button is pressed, but there is a problem with a system
related to the LKAS. The LKAS cancels automatically.
The beeper sounds simultaneously.
●
If any other system indicators come on, such as the
VSA®, ABS and brake system, take appropriate action.
●
Instrument Panel
Appears when the vehicle is driving out of a detected
lane. The beeper sounds simultaneously.
Beeps and a warning display alert you that the vehicle is
drifting out of a detected lane.
●
Continued
91
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with LKAS
Message
Condition
●
●
●
●
Instrument Panel
Use the climate control system to cool down the
camera.
Goes off - The camera has been cooled down. Pressing
the LKAS button and MAIN button can resume the
system.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) * P. 284
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) * P. 297
●
●
92
Appears if the temperature inside the camera is too
high.
The LKAS and ACC have been automatically canceled.
Explanation
Appears when the area around the camera is blocked by
dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe place, and
wipe it off with a soft cloth.
May appear when driving in bad weather (rain, snow,
fog, etc.).
* Not available on all models
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the indicator
and message come back on after you cleaned the area
around the camera.
Gauges and Multi-Information Display
Gauges
Gauges include the speedometer, tachometer, fuel gauge, and related indicators.
They are displayed when the power mode is in ON.
■ Speedometer
Displays your driving speed in mph (U.S.) or km/h (Canada).
Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.
■ Fuel Gauge
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
1Fuel Gauge
Instrument Panel
■ Tachometer
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches E .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
■ Temperature Gauge
Displays the temperature of the engine coolant.
1Temperature Gauge
NOTICE
Driving with the temperature gauge pointer in the
upper zone can cause serious engine damage. Pull
safely to the side of the road and allow engine
temperature to return to normal.
2 Overheating P. 414
93
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Multi-Information Display
The multi-information display shows the odometer, trip meter, outside temperature
indicator, and other gauges. It also displays important messages such as warnings
and other helpful information.
■ Switching the Display
Instrument Panel
■ Main displays
Press the
/
(information) button or the SEL/RESET button to change the display.
Models without full color display
Black Screen
Average Fuel Economy/
Range
Instant Fuel Economy
/
Button
Elapsed Time
Vehicle Settings
SEL/RESET Button
Engine Oil Life
94
Tire Pressure for Each Tire
Average Speed
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Models with full color display
Instant Fuel Economy
Range
Elapsed Time
Average Speed
Turn-by-Turn
Directions *
OFF
/
Instrument Panel
Average Fuel Economy/
Button
SEL/RESET
Button
* Not available on all models
Vehicle Settings
Engine Oil Life
Tire Pressure for
Each Tire
Compass *
Continued
95
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ Lower displays
Press the SEL/RESET button to change the display.
Models without full color display
Odometer
Trip A
Trip B
Instrument Panel
Outside Temperature
SEL/RESET Button
96
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Models with full color display
Odometer
Trip A
Trip B
Instrument Panel
Outside Temperature
SEL/RESET Button
■ Odometer
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) that your vehicle has
accumulated.
Continued
97
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ Trip Meter
Shows the total number of miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada) driven since the last
reset. Meters A and B can be used to measure two separate trips.
1Trip Meter
Switch between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the SEL/RESET button.
■ Resetting a trip meter
Instrument Panel
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button. The trip
meter is reset to 0.0.
■ Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S.) or Celsius (Canada).
■ Adjusting the outside temperature display
Adjust the temperature reading up to ±5°F or ±3°C if the temperature reading
seems incorrect.
1Outside Temperature
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
Use the multi-information display’s customized
features to correct the temperature.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
■ Average Fuel Economy
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in mpg (U.S.) or l/100
km (Canada). The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the
average fuel economy is also reset.
■ Instant Fuel Economy
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg (U.S.) or l/100 km (Canada).
98
1Average Fuel Economy
You can change when to reset the average fuel
economy.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ Range
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is
estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.
■ Elapsed Time
1Elapsed Time
■ Average Speed
1Average Speed
Shows the average speed in mph (U.S.) or km/h (Canada) since Trip A or Trip B was
reset.
■ Turn-by-Turn Directions *
You can change when to reset the average speed.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Instrument Panel
You can change when to reset the elapsed time.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Shows the time elapsed since Trip A or Trip B was reset.
1Turn-by-Turn Directions *
Shows you turn-by-turn driving directions to your destination linked with the
navigation system.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
The multi-information display shows a compass when
the route guidance is not used.
You can select whether the turn-by-turn display
comes on or not during the route guidance.
2 Customized Features P. 106
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
■ Tire Pressure Monitor
Shows each tire’s pressure.
2 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) P. 310
■ Engine Oil Life
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance MinderTM.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 343
* Not available on all models
Continued
99
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Models without full color display
1Customized Features
■ Customized Features
To customize other features, press the
/
button.
2 List of customizable options P. 103
2 Example of customization settings P. 114
Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
Instrument Panel
Select the VEHICLE SETTINGS screen by pressing the
/
power mode is in ON, and the vehicle is at a complete stop.
Press the SEL/RESET button.
button while the
Customization is possible when you see the driver’s
ID (DRIVER 1 or DRIVER 2) on the screen.
The driver’s ID indicates which remote transmitter
you have used to unlock the driver’s door. The
customized settings are recalled every time you
unlock the driver’s door with that remote.
When you customize settings: Shift to (P
Multi-Information Display:
Goes to customize settings.
/
Button:
Changes the customize menus
and items.
SEL/RESET button:
Enters the selected item
100
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ Customization flow
Press the
/
button.
DRIVER ASSIST SYSTEM SETUP *
VEHICLE SETTINGS
SEL/RESET
BLIND SPOT INFO
SEL/RESET
LANGUAGE SELECTION
SEL/RESET
Instrument Panel
ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP. DISPLAY
METER SETUP
“TRIP A” RESET TIMING
“TRIP B” RESET TIMING
DRIVING POSITION SETUP
SEL/RESET
MEMORY POSITION LINK
DOOR UNLOCK MODE
KEYLESS ACCESS SETUP
SEL/RESET
KEYLESS ACCESS LIGHT FLASH
KEYLESS ACCESS BEEP
INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMING TIME
LIGHTING SETUP
SEL/RESET
HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER
AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY
DOOR SETUP
SEL/RESET
AUTO DOOR LOCK
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
DOOR LOCK MODE
KEYLESS LOCK ACKNOWLEDGMENT
SECURITY RELOCK TIMER
* Not available on all models
Continued
101
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
POWER OPEN BY OUTER HANDLE
POWER TAILGATE SETUP
Instrument Panel
POWER TAILGATE KEYLESS OPEN MODE
MAINTENANCE INFO.
DEFAULT ALL
SEL/RESET
102
SEL/RESET
EXIT
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ List of customizable options
Setup Group
METER
SETUP
DRIVING
POSITION
SETUP
Description
Selectable Settings
BLIND SPOT INFO
Changes the setting for the blind spot information.
AUDIBLE AND VISUAL
ALERT*1/VISUAL ALERT/OFF
LANGUAGE SELECTION
Changes the displayed language.
ENGLISH*1/Francais/Español
ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.
DISPLAY
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
“TRIP A” RESET TIMING
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and
elapsed time A.
WITH REFUEL/IGN OFF/
MANUALLY RESET*1
“TRIP B” RESET TIMING
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and
elapsed time B.
WITH REFUEL/IGN OFF/
MANUALLY RESET*1
MEMORY POSITION LINK
Changes the driver’s seat position to a stored
setting.
ON*1/OFF
-5°F ~ ±0°F*1 ~ +5°F (U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C (Canada)
Instrument Panel
DRIVER
ASSIST
SYSTEM
SETUP *
Customizable Features
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
103
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Instrument Panel
KEYLESS
ACCESS
SETUP
LIGHTING
SETUP
Customizable Features
Selectable Settings
DOOR UNLOCK MODE
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle and tailgate handle. When you
press the tailgate release button, if you chose
DRIVER DOOR ONLY, only tailgate is unlatched.
If you chose ALL DOORS, tailgate is unlatched and
all doors are unlocked.
DRIVER DOOR ONLY*1/ALL
DOORS
KEYLESS ACCESS LIGHT
FLASH
Causes some exterior lights to blink when you
unlock/lock the doors.
ON*1/OFF
KEYLESS ACCESS BEEP
Sets the beeper sound or not when you grab the
either front door handle.
ON*1/OFF
INTERIOR LIGHT
DIMMING TIME
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay on
after you close the doors.
60 sec/30 sec*1/15 sec
HEADLIGHT AUTO OFF
TIMER
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver’s door.
60 sec/30 sec/15 sec*1/0 sec
AUTO LIGHT SENSITIVITY
Changes the timing for the headlights to come on.
MAX/HIGH/MID*1/LOW/MIN
*1: Default Setting
104
Description
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
WITH VEH SPD*1/SHIFT FROM
(P /OFF
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
WHEN DRIVER’S DOOR
OPENS*1/WHEN SHIFTING
INTO PARK/WHEN IGNITION
SWITCHED OFF/OFF
DOOR LOCK MODE
Sets up either the driver’s door or all doors to unlock
on the first push of the remote.
DRIVER DOOR*1/ALL DOORS
KEYLESS LOCK
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash. LOCK (2nd
push)- The beeper sounds.
ON*1/OFF
SECURITY RELOCK TIMER
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock and
the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening any door.
90 sec/60 sec/30 sec*1
POWER OPEN BY OUTER
HANDLE
Changes the setting to open power tailgate by
tailgate outer handle.
ON (POWER/MANUAL)*1/OFF
(MANUAL ONLY)
POWER TAILGATE
KEYLESS OPEN MODE
Changes the keyless setting for when the power
tailgate opens.
ANYTIME*1/WHEN
UNLOCKED
MAINTENANCE
INFO.
Resets/Cancels the engine oil life display when you
have performed the maintenance service.
RESET/CANCEL
DEFAULT
ALL
Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as
default.
CANCEL/SET
DOOR
SETUP
POWER
TAILGATE
SETUP
Instrument Panel
AUTO DOOR LOCK
*1: Default Setting
Continued
105
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Models with full color display
1Customized Features
■ Customized Features
Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
Instrument Panel
Select the Vehicle Settings screen by pressing the
/
button while the
power mode is in ON, and the vehicle is at a complete stop.
Press the SEL/RESET button.
To customize other features, press the
/
button.
2 List of customizable options P. 109
2 Example of customization settings P. 114
Customization is possible when you see the driver’s
ID (DRIVER 1 or DRIVER 2) on the screen.
The driver’s ID indicates which remote transmitter
you have used to unlock the driver’s door. The
customized settings are recalled every time you
unlock the driver’s door with that remote.
When you customize settings: Shift to (P
Multi-Information Display:
Goes to customize settings.
/
Button:
Changes the customize menus
and items.
SEL/RESET button:
Enters the selected item
106
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ Customization flow
Press the
/
button.
Vehicle Settings
SEL/RESET
Driver Assist System Setup *
SEL/RESET
Instrument Panel
Forward Collision Warning Distance *
ACC Forward Vehicle Detect Beep *
ACC Display Speed Unit *
Lane Keeping Assist Suspend Beep *
Blind Spot Info *
Meter Setup
SEL/RESET
Language Selection
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
“Trip A” Reset Timing
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Turn by Turn Display *
Driving Position Setup
Keyless Access Setup
SEL/RESET
SEL/RESET
Memory Position Link
Door Unlock Mode
Keyless Access Light Flash
Keyless Access Beep
Remote Start System On/Off *
Interior Light Dimming Time
Lighting Setup
SEL/RESET
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Auto Light Sensitivity
* Not available on all models
Continued
107
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Door Setup
Instrument Panel
Security Relock Timer
Power Open By Outer Handle
Power Tailgate Setup
SEL/RESET
Keyless Open Mode
Maintenance Info.
Default All
SEL/RESET
108
SEL/RESET
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Exit
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
■ List of customizable options
Setup Group
Description
Selectable Settings
Forward Collision
Warning Distance *
Changes at which distance CMBSTM alerts.
Long/Normal*1/Short
ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep *
Causes the system to beep when the system detects a
vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of the ACC range.
On/Off*1
ACC Display Speed Unit *
Changes the speed unit for ACC on the multiinformation display.
mph*1/km/h (U.S.)
mph/km/h*1 (Canada)
Lane Keeping Assist
Suspend Beep *
Causes the system to beep when the LKAS is suspended.
On/Off*1
Blind Spot Info *
Changes the setting for the blind spot information.
Audible And Visual
Alert*1/Visual Alert/Off
Instrument Panel
Driver Assist
System
Setup *
Customizable Features
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
109
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Customizable Features
English*1/Francais/
Español
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F*1 ~ +5°F
(U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C
(Canada)
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and elapsed
time A.
When Refueled/IGN Off/
Manually Reset*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and elapsed
time B.
When Refueled/IGN Off/
Manually Reset*1
Turn by Turn Display *
Selects whether the turn-by-turn display comes on
during the route guidance.
On*1/Off
Instrument Panel
*1:Default Setting
110
Selectable Settings
Changes the displayed language.
Language Selection
Meter Setup
Description
* Not available on all models
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Driving
Position
Setup
Lighting
Setup
Description
Selectable Settings
Memory Position Link
Changes the driver’s seat position to a stored
setting.
On*1/Off
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle and tailgate handle. When you
press the tailgate release button, if you chose Driver
Door Only, only tailgate is unlatched.
If you chose All Doors, tailgate is unlatched and all
doors are unlocked.
Driver Door Only*1/All Doors
Keyless Access Light
Flash
Causes some exterior lights to flash when you
unlock/lock the doors.
On*1/Off
Keyless Access Beep
Causes the beeper to sound when you unlock/lock
the doors.
On*1/Off
Remote Start System On/
Off *
Turns the remote engine start feature on and off.
On*1/Off
Interior Light Dimming
Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay on
after you close the doors.
60sec/30sec*1/15sec
Headlight Auto Off
Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver’s door.
60sec/30sec/15sec*1/0sec
Auto Light Sensitivity
Changes the timing for the headlights to come on.
Max/High/Mid*1/Low/Min
Instrument Panel
Keyless
Access
Setup
Customizable Features
*1: Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
111
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Customizable Features
With Vehicle Speed*1/Shift
From P/Off
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When Driver’s
Door Opens*1/All Doors
When Shifted To Park/All
Doors When Ignition
Switched Off/Off
Key And Remote Unlock
Mode
Sets up either the driver’s door or all doors to unlock
on the first operation of the remote or built-in key.
Driver Door*1/ All Doors
Keyless Lock Answer
Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
On*1/Off
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock and
the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening any door.
90sec/60sec/30sec*1
Instrument Panel
*1: Default Setting
112
Selectable Settings
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
Auto Door Lock
Door Setup
Description
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Changes the setting to open power tailgate by
tailgate outer handle.
On (Power/Manual)*1/Off
(Manual Only)
Keyless Open Mode
Changes the keyless setting for when the power
tailgate opens.
Anytime*1/When Unlocked
Maintenance
Info.
Resets/Cancels the engine oil life display when you
have performed the maintenance service.
Cancel/Reset
Default All
Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as
default.
Cancel/Set
Instrument Panel
Power Open By Outer
Handle
Power
Tailgate
Setup
*1: Default Setting
Continued
113
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
All models
■ Example of customization settings
Instrument Panel
The steps for changing the “TRIP A” RESET TIMING/”Trip A” Reset Timing setting
to WITH REFUEL/When Refueled are shown below. The default setting for “TRIP
A” RESET TIMING/”Trip A” Reset Timing is MANUALLY RESET/Manually
Reset.
1. Press
/
button to select VEHICLE
*1
*2
SETTINGS/Vehicle Settings, then press
the SEL/RESET button.
*1
*1 : Models without full color display
*2 : Models with full color display
114
*2
2. Press the
/
button until METER
SETUP/Meter Setup appears on the
display.
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u LANGUAGE SELECTION/Language
Selection appears first in the display.
uuGauges and Multi-Information DisplayuMulti-Information Display
*2
*1
*2
*1
*2
4. Press the
/
button until “TRIP
A”RESET TIMING/”Trip A” Reset Timing
appears on the display, then press the SEL/
RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select WITH REFUEL/When
Refueled, IGN OFF/IGN Off,
MANUALLY RESET/Manually Reset,
or EXIT/Exit.
5. Press the
/
button and select WITH
REFUEL/When Refueled, then press the
SEL/RESET button.
u The WITH REFUEL/When Refueled
setup screen appears, then the display
returns to the customization menu
screen.
Instrument Panel
*1
6. Press the
/
button until EXIT/Exit
appears on the display, then press the SEL/
RESET button.
7. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the
normal screen.
*1 : Models without full color display
*2 : Models with full color display
115
116
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Setting the Clock .............................. 118
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions .................. 119
Low Keyless Access Remote Signal Strength..... 122
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Outside .......................................... 123
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside ... 128
Childproof Door Locks ..................... 129
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking .......... 130
Opening and Closing the Tailgate... 131
Security System
Immobilizer System .......................... 137
Security System Alarm...................... 137
* Not available on all models
Opening and Closing the Windows .... 140
Opening and Closing the Moonroof ....... 143
Operating the Switches Around the
Steering Wheel
ENGINE START/STOP Button............. 144
Turn Signals ..................................... 147
Light Switches.................................. 147
Fog Lights * ...................................... 150
Daytime Running Lights ................... 150
Wipers and Washers ........................ 151
Brightness Control ........................... 154
Adjusting the Steering Wheel .......... 158
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror ................... 159
Power Door Mirrors ......................... 160
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions............. 162
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button ...155
Interior Lights .................................. 169
Interior Convenience Items .............. 171
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control .... 180
Synchronized Mode ......................... 182
Driving Position Memory System ...... 156
Automatic Climate Control Sensors.....183
117
Setting the Clock
Clock
You can adjust the time in the clock display with the power mode in ON.
■ Using the SETUP button
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Adjust Clock, then press .
Controls
118
3. Rotate
to select the item you want to
change (12/24 hour mode, hour, minute).
Then press .
4. Rotate
to make the adjustment.
5. Press
to enter your selection. The display
returns to Adjust Clock. Repeat steps 3 to
5 to adjust other items.
6. To enter the selection, Rotate
and select
Set, then press .
7. Press the SETUP button to go back to the
normal display.
1Clock
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
To set the time to the nearest hour:
Press and hold the CLOCK button until Adjust Clock
appears, then press the (6 (Reset) button.
Depending on the displayed time, the clock sets
forward or backward.
Example:
1:06 will reset to 1:00
1:53 will reset to 2:00
Models with navigation system
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions
This vehicle comes with the following keys:
1Key Types and Functions
■ Keys
Models without two-way keyless
access remote
Use the keyless access remote to start and
stop the engine, and to lock and unlock all the
doors and tailgate. You can also use the
keyless access system to lock and unlock the
doors and tailgate.
Models with two-way keyless
access remote
The keys contain precision electronics.
Adhere to the following advice to prevent damage to
the electronics:
• Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
• Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
• Keep the keys away from liquids.
• Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine
may not start, and the keyless access system may not
work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
Controls
HOLD
All of the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 137
Models with two-way keyless access remote
You can remotely start the engine using the two-way
keyless access remote.
2 Remote Engine Start with Vehicle
Feedback * P. 270
HOLD
* Not available on all models
Continued
119
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Keyless access remote
Models without two-way keyless
access remote
Release Knob
Controls
Built-in Key
Models with two-way keyless
access remote
Release Knob
Built-in Key
120
The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the
doors and the tailgate when the keyless access
remote battery becomes weak and the power
door lock/unlock operation is disabled.
To remove the built-in key, pull it out while
pressing the release button. To reinstall the
built-in key, push the built-in key into the
keyless access remote until it clicks.
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of your vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine,
contact a dealer.
Controls
121
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Keyless Access Remote Signal Strength
Low Keyless Access Remote Signal Strength
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the keyless access remote when locking/
unlocking the doors, opening the tailgate, or to start the engine.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors or opening the tailgate or
starting the engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
• You are carrying the keyless access remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, cell phones, or wireless devices.
• A metallic object is touching or covering the keyless access remote.
Controls
122
1Low Keyless Access Remote Signal Strength
Communication between the keyless access remote
and the vehicle consumes the keyless access remote’s
battery.
The keyless access remote battery lasts about two
years. This changes by how often you use the remote.
The battery is consumed whenever the keyless access
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Keyless Access System
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
When you carry the keyless access remote,
you can lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate.
■ Locking the doors and tailgate
Door Lock
Button
Press the door lock button on the front door
or the tailgate.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all the doors and tailgate lock;
and the security system sets.
1Using the Keyless Access System
• The driver must carry the keyless access remote and
not leave it in the vehicle when you get out.
• A person who is not carrying the keyless access
remote can lock/unlock the doors if a person who
is carrying it is within range.
• The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the keyless access remote is within range.
• If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the
door sensor may be slow to respond or may not
respond by unlocking the doors.
• The door might not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Controls
You can lock/unlock the doors within a radius
of about 32 inches (80 cm) of the outside door
handle. You can open the tailgate within
about 32 inches (80 cm) radius from the
tailgate release button.
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter or keyless access system only when the
power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.
Lock Button
Continued
123
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors and tailgate
Controls
Tailgate Release
Button
Grab the driver’s door handle:
u The driver’s door unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Grab the front passenger’s door handle:
u All the doors unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Press the tailgate release button:
u The tailgate unlocks and opens.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
2 Using the Tailgate Release Button P. 132
124
1Using the Keyless Access System
• Even within the 32 inches (80 cm) radius, you may
not be able to lock/unlock the doors with the
keyless access remote if it is above or below the
outside handle.
• The keyless access remote may not operate if it is
too close to the door and door glass.
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle, the doors will automatically
relock.
The light flash, beep and unlock settings can be
customized using the multi-information display.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
■ Locking the doors
LED
Unlock
Button
1Using the Remote Transmitter
Lock
Button
LED*1
■ Unlocking the doors
Unlock
Button
Lock
Button
Press the unlock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash twice, and the
driver’s door unlocks.
Twice:
u The remaining doors and tailgate unlock.
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior lights come on when you press
the unlock button.
No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30
seconds.
Doors relocked with the remote: The lights go off
immediately.
2 Interior Lights P. 169
Controls
Press the lock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash, all the doors
and tailgate lock, and the security system
sets.
Twice (within five seconds after the first
push):
u A beeper sounds and verifies the security
system is set.
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds of
unlocking the vehicle with the remote transmitter,
the doors will automatically relock.
You can change the relock timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
The remote will not lock the vehicle when a door is
open.
If the distance at which it works varies, the battery is
probably low.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 380
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
*1 : Checking Door Lock Status * P. 127
* Not available on all models
Continued
125
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
Fully insert the key and turn it.
Lock
Unlock
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
When you lock the driver’s door with a key, all of the
other doors and tailgate lock at the same time. When
unlocking, the driver’s door unlocks first. Turn the
key a second time within a few seconds to unlock the
remaining doors and the tailgate.
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Controls
■ Locking a Door Without Using a Key
■ Locking the driver’s door
Push the lock tab forward a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, and close the door.
■ Locking the passenger’s doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
■ Lockout prevention system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the keyless access remote is
inside the vehicle, and any door or the tailgate is open.
126
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
When you lock the driver’s door, all the other doors
and tailgate lock at the same time.
Make sure you have the key with you when locking a
door from the outside.
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Checking Door Lock Status *
Red
Green
Amber
You can remotely check if your vehicle’s doors
are all locked or any are unlocked using the
keyless access remote from extended
distances.
Lock Button
1Checking Door Lock Status *
Operate the remote in an open space. If there are
buildings or other obstacles between your vehicle
and the remote, the remote may not work even
within the operable range. However, the range of
unlock, all doors, and panic functions are the same as
the standard keyless access remote.
2 Using the Remote Transmitter P. 125
Controls
When checking the door lock status, you can also
start or stop the engine.
2 Remote Engine Start with Vehicle
Feedback * P. 270
Press the lock button, the Amber (left) LED blinks once. Then after three seconds one
of the following feedback will come:
• Green (center) comes on: Acknowledges that the doors are locked.
• Red (right) comes on: Acknowledges that doors are not locked, or any door is not
completely closed.
• Red (right) blinks three times: The remote does not receive the door lock status
from the vehicle.
* Not available on all models
127
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Lock Tab
To Lock
Lock Tab
1Using the Lock Tab
■ Locking a door
Push the lock tab forward.
■ Unlocking a door
To Unlock
Pull the lock tab rearward.
Controls
■ Unlocking Using the Inner Handle of Front Doors
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
Inner
Handle
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, all the other doors and tailgate lock at
the same time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, only the driver’s door will unlock.
1Unlocking Using the Inner Handle of Front Doors
The front door inner handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 129
128
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
■ Using the Master Door Lock Switch
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate.
To Lock
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
When you lock/unlock the driver’s door using the
master door lock switch, all the other doors and the
tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.
To Unlock
Controls
Master Door
Lock Switch
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
■ Setting the Childproof Door Locks
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
1Childproof Door Locks
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
■ When opening the door
Unlock
Open the door using the outside door handle.
Lock
129
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuAuto Door Locking/Unlocking
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Your vehicle locks all doors and unlocks all doors or the driver’s door automatically
when a certain condition is met.
■ Auto Door Locking
■ Drive lock mode
All doors and tailgate lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15 km/h).
■ Auto Door Unlocking
Controls
130
■ Driver’s door open mode
All doors unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
1Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the multi-information
display.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Opening and Closing the Tailgate
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or
closing it.
■ Opening the tailgate
• Open the tailgate all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may come down accidentally by its own
weight.
• Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.
Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 62
Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to
put your hands between the tailgate and the cargo
area when closing the gate.
When operating the power tailgate, make sure there
is enough space around your vehicle. People near the
tailgate may be seriously hurt if the tailgate hits or
closes on their heads. Be especially cautious if
children are around.
When you are storing or picking up luggage from the
cargo area while the engine is idling, do not stand in
front of the exhaust pipe. You may get burned.
Controls
■ Closing the tailgate
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Do not allow any passenger in the cargo space. They
may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden
acceleration, or a crash.
131
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuUsing the Tailgate Release Button
Using the Tailgate Release Button
When all the doors are unlocked or press the
tailgate unlock button on the remote
transmitter, the tailgate is unlocked.
1Using the Tailgate Release Button
• Do not leave the keyless access remote in the
vehicle when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the keyless access
Tailgate
Release
Button
Controls
Press the tailgate release button for more than
one second, and wait until you hear two
beeps before you lift open the tailgate.
u Releasing the release button within one
second with one beep enables the power
tailgate operations.
2 Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate
P. 133
If you are carrying the keyless access remote,
you do not have to unlock the tailgate before
opening it.
To manually close the tailgate, grab the inner
handle, pull the tailgate down, and push it
closed from outside.
Inner Handle
132
remote, you can unlock the tailgate while someone
else with the remote is within range.
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate
Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate
The power tailgate can be operated by pressing the power tailgate button on the
remote transmitter, pressing the power tailgate switch on the dashboard, or
pressing the button on the tailgate.
1Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate
3 WARNING
Closing a power tailgate while anyone is
in the path of the tailgate can cause
serious injury.
■ The power tailgate can be opened when:
• The tailgate is fully closed.
• The shift lever is in (P .
Make sure everyone is clear before
closing the power tailgate.
■ The power tailgate can be closed when:
NOTICE
Do not push or pull on the power tailgate when it is
being automatically opened or closed.
Forcibly opening or closing the power tailgate while
in operation can deform the tailgate frame.
Controls
• The tailgate is fully open.
• The shift lever is in (P .
When operating the power tailgate, make sure there
is enough space around your vehicle. People near the
tailgate may be seriously hurt if the tailgate hits or
closes on their heads. Be especially cautious if
children are around.
The power tailgate may not open or close under the
following conditions:
• You start the engine while the tailgate is automatically
opening or closing.
• The vehicle is parked on a steep hill.
• The vehicle is swayed in a strong wind.
• The tailgate or the roof is covered with snow or ice.
If you close the power tailgate when all the doors are
locked, the power tailgate locks automatically.
Continued
133
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate
■ Remote Transmitter
HOLD
1Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate
Press the power tailgate button for more than
one second to operate.
If you replace the battery or the power tailgate fuse
while the tailgate is open, the power tailgate may be
disabled. The power tailgate resumes once you
manually close the tailgate.
To reverse direction while the power tailgate is
in operation, press the button again. The
beeper sounds three times and the tailgate
reverses direction.
Installing aftermarket components other than Acura
genuine accessories on the power tailgate may
prevent it from fully opening or closing.
Controls
Make sure the power tailgate is fully open before you
get your luggage in and out.
Power
Tailgate
Button
Make sure the power tailgate is fully closed before
you start the vehicle.
The beeper sounds when you start driving while the
power tailgate is still open, or closing.
HOLD
If the power tailgate meets resistance while opening
or closing, the auto reverse feature reverses the
direction. The beeper sounds three times.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
tailgate is almost closed to make sure that it fully
closes.
■ Customizing when to open the tailgate
ANYTIME/Anytime: The power tailgate unlocks and opens at the same time. This
is the default setting.
WHEN UNLOCKED/When Unlocked: The tailgate opens when all doors are
unlocked.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
134
Do not touch the sensors located on both sides of the
tailgate. The power tailgate does not close if you
touch either sensor when you are trying to close the
tailgate.
Be careful not to scratch the sensors with a sharp
object. If scratched, they can be damaged, and the
power tailgate closing feature malfunctions.
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate
■ Power Tailgate Button
To open or close the power tailgate, press the
power tailgate button on the dashboard for
about one second. The beeper sounds and
some exterior lights flash.
■ Power Tailgate Close Button
Controls
Power Tailgate Button
To reverse direction while the power tailgate is
in operation, press the button again. The
beeper sounds three times and the tailgate
reverses direction.
1Power Tailgate Close Button
Press the button on the tailgate to close the
power tailgate.
If you press the button again while the power
tailgate is closing, it stops and reverses
direction.
If you push the power tailgate close button while the
tailgate is automatically opening or closing, the
power tailgate operation stops. Use caution if the
tailgate stops in the middle of either operation. It may
suddenly swing up or down.
1Auto-Closer
The auto-closer feature does not activate if you push
the tailgate release button while the power tailgate is
closing.
Power Tailgate
Close Button
Do not put any force on the tailgate while the power
tailgate is latching.
■ Auto-Closer
If you manually close the power tailgate, it latches automatically.
Keep your hands away from the tailgate when you
manually close the tailgate and let it latch
automatically. It is dangerous to put your hands
around the tailgate as it starts to latch itself.
Continued
135
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate
■ Power Tailgate Fail-safe Mode
The power tailgate fail-safe mode detects if there is an extra load on the tailgate (for
example, it is covered with snow). If an extra load is detected, the tailgate opens
completely then lowers to the close position.
1Power Tailgate Fail-safe Mode
If you try to manually close the power tailgate
immediately after it fully opens, the power tailgate
fail-safe mode may activate.
Once the power tailgate fail-safe mode activates,
wait until the power tailgate fully closes. Keep away
from the power tailgate when it is in motion.
Controls
136
If the power tailgate fail-safe mode constantly
activates, consult at a dealer.
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
NOTICE
Leaving the keyless access remote in the vehicle can
result in theft or accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the key with you whenever you leave the
vehicle unattended.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
Controls
Pay attention to the following when selecting the ACCESSORY mode with the
ENGINE START/STOP button:
• Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ENGINE START/
STOP button.
• Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
• Do not bring a key from another vehicle’s immobilizer system with the keyless
access remote.
1Immobilizer System
Security System Alarm
The security system alarm activates when the doors, tailgate, or hood are opened
without the key, remote transmitter or keyless access system.
1Security System Alarm
The security alarm continues for a maximum of two
minutes until the security system alarm deactivates.
However, the alarm goes off when a door is opened with the key, then the shift
lever is moved out of (P or the hood is opened before the power mode is set to ON.
■ When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently, and all of the exterior lights flash.
■ To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the remote transmitter, or keyless access system. The
system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is deactivated.
Continued
137
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ Setting the security system alarm
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
• The power mode is in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
• The hood is closed.
• All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, remote
transmitter, or keyless access system.
■ When the security system alarm sets
Controls
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the
blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system alarm is set.
■ To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is canceled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote
transmitter, keyless access system, or the power mode is set to ON. The security
system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.
138
1Security System Alarm
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when:
• Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
• Moving the shift lever out of (P .
If the battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may go off
once the battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the remote transmitter, or
keyless access system.
Do not attempt to alter this system or add another
device to it.
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ Panic Mode
■ The panic button on the remote
PANIC
Button
transmitter
If you press the PANIC button for
approximately one second, the following will
occur for about 30 seconds:
• The horn sounds.
• Some exterior lights flash.
Controls
PANIC
Button
■ Canceling panic mode
Press any button on the remote transmitter, or set the power mode to ON.
139
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the power mode is in ON,
using the switches on the doors. The driver side switches can be used to open and
close all of the windows.
The power window lock button on the driver side must be switched off (not pushed
in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than the
driver’s seat.
Controls
When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you
can only operate the driver’s window. Turn the power window lock button on when
children are in the vehicle.
■ Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function
ON
OFF
Power Window
Lock Button
Driver’s
Window
Switch
Indicator
Front Passenger’s
Window Switch
■ Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
■ Manual operation
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
140
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
3 WARNING
Closing a power window on someone’s
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF.
Opening either front door cancels this function.
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it will stop closing and reverse
direction.
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close Function
To open: Push the switch down.
To close: Pull the switch up.
Close
Release the switch when the window reaches
the desired position.
Open
Controls
Continued
141
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening the Windows and Moonroof with the Remote
To open: Press the UNLOCK button twice
within 10 seconds and hold it down for the
second time. If the windows stop midway,
repeat the procedure.
Unlock
Button
Controls
■ Opening/Closing the Windows and Moonroof with the Key
Open
Close
To open: Unlock the driver’s door with the
key. Within 10 seconds of returning the key to
the central position, turn the key in the unlock
direction and hold it there.
To close: Lock the driver’s door with the key.
Within 10 seconds of returning the key to the
central position, turn the key in the lock
direction and hold it there.
Release the key to stop the windows/
moonroof at the desired position. If you want
further adjustment, repeat the same
operation.
142
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
■ Opening/Closing the Moonroof
You can only operate the moonroof when the power mode is in ON. Use the switch
in the front of the ceiling to open and close the moonroof.
■ Automatic operation
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
Open
Tilt
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
■ Tilting the moonroof up
To tilt: Push on the center of the moonroof
switch.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly, then
release.
3 WARNING
Opening or closing the moonroof on
someone’s hands or fingers can cause
serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the moonroof before opening or closing it.
NOTICE
Opening the moonroof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the moonroof panel or motor.
Controls
Close
The moonroof will automatically open or close
all the way. To stop the moonroof midway,
touch the switch briefly.
1Opening/Closing the Moonroof
The power moonroof can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF.
Opening either front door cancels this function.
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse
function causes the moonroof to change directions,
then stop. Auto reverse stops sensing when the
moonroof is almost closed to ensure that it fully
closes. Make sure that all objects, including fingers,
are clear of the moonroof.
143
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
ENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Changing the Power Mode
ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range
Indicator
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
Indicator in the button is off.
The steering wheel is locked. The power
to all electrical components is turned off.
Controls
ACCESSORY
Indicator in the button is on.
Indicator in the button blinks (from ON to
ACCESSORY).
Operate the audio system and other
accessories in this position.
ON
Indicator in the button is on.
All electrical components
can be used.
Without pressing the brake pedal
: Press the ENGINE START/STOP button to change the mode.
: Press the button without the shift lever in (P .
: Shift to Park, then press the button.
U.S. models
: Shift to (P .
144
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
Operating Range
You can start the engine when the keyless access
remote is inside the vehicle.
The engine may also run if the keyless access remote
is close to the door or window, even if it is outside the
vehicle.
ON mode:
Indicator in the button is off, if the engine is running.
If the keyless access remote battery is weak, beeper
sounds and the TO START, HOLD REMOTE NEAR
START BUTTON/To Start, Hold Remote Near
Start Button message appears on the multiinformation display.
2 If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is
Weak P. 409
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Power Mode Reminder
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning
buzzer sounds.
If the power mode does not change from VEHICLE
OFF to ACCESSORY, press the ENGINE START/STOP
button while moving the steering wheel left and
right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the
mode to change.
Controls
Continued
145
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Keyless Access Remote Reminder
Models with full color display
Models without full color display
Warning buzzers may sound from inside or/
and outside the vehicle to remind you that the
keyless access remote is out of the vehicle. If
the buzzer continues even after the remote is
put back inside, place it within its operational
range.
Controls
■ When the power mode is in ON
If the keyless access remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed,
warning buzzers sound from both inside and
outside the vehicle. A warning message on
the multi-information display notifies the
driver inside that the remote is out.
■ When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY or in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
If the keyless access remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from outside the
vehicle.
146
1Keyless Access Remote Reminder
When the keyless access remote is within the
system’s operational range, and the driver’s door is
closed, the warning function cancels.
If the keyless access remote is taken out of the vehicle
after the engine has been started, you can no longer
change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or
restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is
in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
Removing the keyless access remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Do not put a keyless access remote on the dashboard
or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer
to go off. Under some other conditions that can
prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the
warning buzzer may also go off even if the remote is
within the system’s operational range.
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Turn Signals
Right Turn
The turn signals can be used when the power
mode is in ON.
■ One-touch turn signal
Left Turn
When you lightly push up or down and release
the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals
and turn signal indicator blink three times.
Controls
This feature can be used when signaling for a
lane change.
Light Switches
1Light Switches
■ Manual Operation
High Beams
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Turns on parking, side marker,
tail, and rear license plate lights
Turns on headlights, parking, side
marker, tail, and rear license plate
lights
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the power mode
setting.
■ High beams
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
■ Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
■ Flashing the high beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
Continued
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off
because it will cause the battery to discharge.
147
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Lighting Control
1Automatic Lighting Control
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the power mode is in ON.
Controls
When you turn the light switch to #Y , the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
u You can change the auto light sensitivity
setting.
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Light Sensor
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Adjust the auto light sensitivity as follows:
Setting
MAX
HIGH
MID
LOW
MIN
148
The exterior lights come on
when the ambient light is at
Bright
Dark
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Headlight Integration with Wiper *
The headlights automatically come on when the wipers are used several times within
certain number of intervals while the headlight switch is in #Y .The headlights
automatically go off a few minutes after the wipers are stopped.
■ Automatic Lighting Off Feature
If you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) with the headlight switch on, but
do not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (three minutes, if the
switch is in the #Y position).
This feature activates while the headlights are in
#Y . The instrument panel brightness does not
change when the headlights come on.
If the ambient light is dark, the automatic lighting
control overrides this feature, and the headlights
come on whether or not the wipers cycle several
times.
1Automatic Lighting Off Feature
You can change the headlight auto off timer setting.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Controls
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), take the remote with
you, and close the driver’s door.
1Headlight Integration with Wiper *
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver’s door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver’s door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
* Not available on all models
149
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights *
Fog Lights *
When the low beam headlights are on, turn
the fog light switch on to use the fog lights.
Fog Light Switch
Controls
Daytime Running Lights
The position/daytime running lights comes on when the following conditions have
been met:
• The power mode is in ON.
• The headlight switch is off, AUTO, or in
.
• The parking brake is released.
The lights remain on even if you set the parking brake. Setting the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) will turn off the daytime running lights.
The daytime running lights are off the headlight switch is turned on, or when the
headlight switch is in AUTO and it is getting darker outside.
150
* Not available on all models
1Fog Lights *
The fog lights go off when the headlights turn off, or
when the daytime running lights are on.
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Wipers and Washers
■ Front Wiper/Washer
1Wipers and Washers
The windshield wipers and washers can be
used when the power mode is in ON.
■ MIST
Pull to
use
washer.
MIST
OFF
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT *, LO, HI)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
■ Adjusting wiper operation
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust wiper
operation.
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
INT: Low speed with intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens.
When the vehicle starts moving, the wipers make a
single sweep.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation’s
shortest delay setting ( ) and the LO setting become
the same.
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
Higher speed, more sweeps
■ Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever toward you.
When you release the lever for more than one
second, the spray stops, the wipers sweep two
or three more times to clear the windshield,
then stop.
* Not available on all models
NOTICE
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windshield, becoming stuck.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the defroster to warm the
windshield, then turn the wipers on.
Controls
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windshield is dry.
The windshield will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
Continued
The wiper motor is equipped with a breaker that may
stop motor operation temporarily to prevent an
overload. Wiper operation will return to normal
within a few minutes, once the circuit has returned to
normal.
151
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
1Wipers and Washers
When you push the lever down to AUTO, the
windshield wipers sweep once, and go into
the automatic mode.
Controls
The wipers operate intermittently, at low
speed, or at high speed and stop in
accordance with the amount of rainfall the
rainfall sensor detects.
If the wiper stops operating due to any obstacle such
as the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe
place.
Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and set the power
mode to ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then
remove the obstacle.
1Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
The rainfall sensor is in the location shown below.
■ Auto sensitivity adjustment
When in AUTO, you can also adjust the
rainfall sensor sensitivity using the intermittent
time adjustment ring.
Rainfall Sensor
Sensor sensitivity
Low sensitivity:
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
High sensitivity:
Higher speed, more sweeps
152
* Not available on all models
NOTICE
Always ensure the wiper lever is in the OFF position
before entering a car wash to prevent severe damage
to the windshield wiper system.
If the wiper lever is in AUTO, and the power mode is
in ON, the rainfall sensor may respond to your hand
or car wash liquids, and the wipers may operate
automatically.
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Rear Wiper/Washer
The rear wiper and washer can be used when
the power mode is in ON.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
INT: Intermittent
ON: Continuous wipe
OFF
Washer
)
Sprays while you rotate the switch to this
position.
Hold it to activate the wiper and to spray the
washer. Once released, it stops operating
after a few more sweeps.
Controls
■ Washer (
■ Operating in reverse
When you shift the transmission to (R with the front wiper activated, the rear wiper
operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.
Front Wiper Position
Rear Wiper Operation
INT (Intermittent)
Intermittent
LO (Low speed wipe)
HI (High speed wipe)
Continuous
153
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Brightness Control
When the power mode is in ON, you can use
the brightness control knob to adjust
instrument panel brightness.
Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.
Dim: Turn the knob to the left.
Control Knob
Controls
Models with full color display
You will hear a beep when the brightness
reaches minimum or maximum. The multiinformation display will return to its original
state several seconds after you adjust the
brightness.
■ Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the multiinformation display while you are adjusting it.
Models without full color display
154
1Brightness Control
Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on
whether the exterior lights are on or off. The
instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are
on.
When it is bright outside and the headlight
integration with the wiper is activated, the
instrument panel brightness does not change.
Pressing the
display.
(SEL/RESET) knob switches the
If you turn the knob to the right until the brightness
display is up to max, a beep sound. This cancels the
reduced instrument panel brightness when the
exterior lights are on.
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluRear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
Press the rear defogger and heated door mirror button to defog the rear window
and mirrors when the power mode is in ON.
The rear defogger and heated door mirrors
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 32°F
(0°C) or below, they do not automatically
switch off.
1Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror Button
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be
careful not to damage the heating wires.
It is critical to wipe the window from side to side
along the defogger heating wires.
Controls
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long period when
the engine is idling. This may weaken the battery,
making it difficult to start the engine.
155
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System
Driving Position Memory System
You can store two driver’s seat and door mirror positions with the driving position
memory system.
When you unlock and open the driver’s door with a remote transmitter, the seat and
door mirrors adjust automatically to one of the two preset positions.
The multi-information display shows you which remote transmitter you used to
unlock the vehicle when you enter.
• Driver 1 transmitter is linked to memory button 1.
• Driver 2 transmitter is linked to memory button 2.
Controls
156
Driver 1
Driver 2
1Driving Position Memory System
Using the multi-information display, you can disable
the automatic seat adjustment function.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System
■ Storing a Position in Memory
Memory
Button 1
Memory
Button 2
SET Button
■ Recalling the Stored Position
Memory
Button 1
Memory
Button 2
SET Button
1. Move the shift lever to (P .
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Press a memory button ( (1 or (2 ).
u You will hear a beep, and the indicator
light will blink.
After you press the SET button, the storing operation
will be canceled when:
• You do not press the memory button within five
seconds.
• You readjust the seat position before the doublebeep.
• You readjust the door mirrors.
• You set the power mode to any position except
ON.
Controls
1. Set the power mode to ON. Adjust the
driver’s seat and the door mirrors to the
desired position.
2. Press the SET button.
u You will hear a beep, and the memory
button indicator light will blink.
3. Press and hold memory button (1 or (2
within five seconds of pressing the SET
button.
u Once the seat and the door mirrors
position has been memorized, the
indicator light on the button you pressed
stays on.
1Storing a Position in Memory
1Recalling the Stored Position
The seat and the door mirrors will stop moving if you:
• Press the SET button, or a memory button ( (1 or
(2 ).
• Adjust the seat position.
• Adjust the door mirrors.
• Shift into any position except (P .
The seat and the door mirrors will
automatically move to the memorized
positions. When they have finished moving,
you will hear a beep, and the indicator light
stays on.
157
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
Controls
158
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.
To adjust
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
in or out.
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
3. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
To lock
Lever
down to lock the steering wheel in position.
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
3 WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
Make any steering wheel adjustments before you
start driving.
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
■ Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror and Power Door Mirrors *
When driving after dark, the automatic
dimming rearview mirror and power door
mirrors * reduce the glare from headlights
behind you.
* Not available on all models
Keep the inside and door mirrors clean and adjusted
for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Adjusting the Seat Positions P. 162
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror and Power Door Mirrors *
The auto dimming function cancels when the shift
position is in (R .
Controls
Sensor
1Adjusting the Mirrors
159
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Power Door Mirrors
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
power mode is in ON.
Folding Button *
■ Mirror position adjustment
Controls
Adjustment
Switch
Selector
Switch
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the center position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
■ Folding door mirrors *
Press the folding button to fold in and out the
door mirrors.
■ Reverse Tilt Door Mirror
Selector Switch
If activated, either side door mirror
automatically tilts downward when you put
the shift lever in (R ; this improves close-in
visibility on the selected side of the vehicle
when reversing. The mirror automatically
returns to its original position when you shift
out of (R .
To activate this feature, set the power mode
to ON, and slide the selector switch to the left
or right side.
160
* Not available on all models
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
■ Expanded View Driver’s Mirror
Inner Segment
Objects visible in the outer segment of the driver side
door mirror appear smaller than objects in the rest of
the mirror. But in fact, they are closer than they
appear.
Do not rely on your mirrors. Always look to the side
and behind your vehicle before changing lanes.
Controls
Outer Segment
The driver side door mirror has outer and inner
segments.
The outer segment is slightly curved to provide
a wider angle view than a standard flat mirror.
This wider view may help you check areas that
are not visible using a standard door mirror.
1Expanded View Driver’s Mirror
161
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions
Allow sufficient
space.
Move back.
Controls
Adjust the driver’s seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger’s seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
■ Adjusting the front power seats
1Adjusting the Seats
3 WARNING
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow
at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
Lumbar Support
Adjustment *
Height Adjustment *
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
162
* Not available on all models
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the center of the steering wheel.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant’s chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
Continued
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back. Doing so may interfere with
proper seat belt or airbag operation.
Controls
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
3 WARNING
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
163
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints
in all seating positions.
Controls
Position head in the center
of the head restraint.
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rearimpact crash injuries when the center of the
back of the occupant’s head rests against the
center of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant’s ears should be level with the
center height of the restraint.
■ Adjusting the front and rear outer head restraint positions
To raise the head restraint: Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint: Push it down
while pressing the release button.
164
1Adjusting the Head Restraints
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
For the head restraint system to work properly:
• Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
• Do not place any object between an occupant and
the seat-back.
• Install each restraint in its proper location.
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Changing the Rear Center Seat Head Restraint Position
■ Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
Controls
A passenger sitting in a center back seating
position should adjust the height of their head
restraint to an appropriate position before the
vehicle begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
3 WARNING
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
Continued
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
165
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is
off.
Controls
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
166
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3 WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
Rear Seats
■ Folding Down the Rear Seats
1Folding Down the Rear Seats
Separately fold down the left and right halves of the rear seat to make room for
cargo.
■ To fold down the seat
1. Store the center seat belt first. Insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the
anchor buckle.
2. Retract the seat belt into the holder on the ceiling.
3. Lower the center head restraint to its lowest position. Put the armrest back into
the seat-back.
When you fold down one side of the rear seats and
use the non-recessed part of the cargo area, make
sure to secure the cargo. Loose items can fly forward
and cause injury if you have to brake hard.
The front seats must be far enough forward so they
do not interfere with the rear seats as they fold
down.
Make sure all items in the cargo area or items
extending to the rear seats are properly
secured. Loose items can fly forward if you have
to brake hard.
From the rear door side
4. Pull the release lever.
Controls
2 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 34
Remove any items from the rear seat cushion and
floor before you fold down the rear seat.
Pull
From the cargo area side
4. Pull the release lever.
Lever
Continued
167
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
■ To return the seat to the original
position
Pull up the seat-back in the upright position.
Controls
Armrest
■ Using the Rear Seat Armrest
Pull down the armrest in the center seat-back.
168
1To return the seat to the original position
Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat
cushion are securely latched back into place before
driving. Also, make sure all rear shoulder belts are
positioned in front of the seat-back, and the center
shoulder belt is re-positioned in the holding slot.
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
■ Interior Light Switches
1Interior Light Switches
■ ON
Front
Door Activated
Position
Off
On
Off
Door Activated Position
■ Map Lights
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the
button.
You can change the interior lights dimming time.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
Controls
On
Rear
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
■ Door activated
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
• When any of the doors are opened.
• You unlock the driver’s door.
• When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
■ OFF
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade
out and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are
closed.
The lights go off after 30 seconds in the following
situations:
• When you unlock the driver’s door but do not open
it.
• When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) but do not open a door.
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
• When you lock the driver’s door.
• When you close the driver’s door in ACCESSORY
mode.
• When you set the power mode to ON.
If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
1Map Lights
When the interior light switch is in the door activated
position and any door is open, the map light will not
go off when you press the button.
Continued
169
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Cargo Area Lights
■ ON
On
Off
The light comes on when you open the
tailgate, and goes off when closed.
■ OFF
The light stays off with or without opening the
tailgate.
Controls
170
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Interior Convenience Items
■ Glove Box
1Glove Box
Press the button to open the glove box. You
can lock the glove box with the built-in key.
To Lock
Glove Box
3 WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Controls
■ Removable shelf
The shelf in the glove box is detachable. To
remove it, disengage the tabs.
Shelf
Tab
The removed shelf can be stored upside down
in the glove box.
Continued
171
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Console Compartment
Pull the handle to open the console
compartment.
Controls
172
Slide the lid using the release knob to open or
close the console compartment.
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
NOTICE
■ Front seat beverage holders
Are located in the console between the front
seats.
Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting,
and electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
Controls
■ Rear seat beverage holders
Fold the armrest down to use the rear seat
beverage holders.
Continued
173
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory Power Sockets
The accessory power sockets can be used when the power mode is in ACCESSORY
or ON.
■ Accessory power socket (console
compartment)
Open the cover to use it.
1Accessory Power Sockets
NOTICE
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
The accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts or less (15 amps).
Controls
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the engine running.
When each socket is being used simultaneously, the
combined power rating of the accessories should not
exceed 180 watts (15 amps).
174
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Coat Hooks
1Coat Hooks
There is a coat hook on the rear grab handle
of both sides. Pull it down to use it.
The coat hooks are not designed for large or heavy
items.
Controls
■ Cargo Hooks
Use floor cargo hooks to secure luggage in the
cargo area.
Hooks
Hooks
Continued
175
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Sunglasses Holder
1Sunglasses Holder
To open the sunglasses holder, push and
release the indent. To close, push it again until
it latches.
Push
Controls
176
You can store eyeglasses and other small
items in this holder.
Keep the holder closed while driving except when
accessing stored items.
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Seat Heaters and Ventilation
1Front Seat Heaters *
3 WARNING
■ Front Seat Heaters *
If the power mode is in ON: The HI setting
heats the seats faster than the LO setting.
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
While in HI, the heater cycles on and off.
u The appropriate indicator will be on
while the seat heater is on. Briefly press
the switch on the opposite side to turn
the heater off. The indicator will be off.
When a comfortable temperature is
reached, select LO to keep the seat
warm.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Controls
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
177
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Front Seat Heaters and Ventilation *
If the power mode is in ON:
Seat heater - The HI setting heats the seats
faster than the LO setting.
Seat ventilation - The HI setting ventilates
the seats faster than the LO setting.
Controls
Press the seat heater or the seat ventilation
button:
Once - The HI setting (three indicators on)
Twice - The MID setting (two indicators on)
Three times - The LO setting
Four times - The OFF setting (no indicators on)
When a comfortable temperature is reached
while using the seat heaters in HI, select MID
or LO to keep the seat warm.
178
* Not available on all models
1Front Seat Heaters and Ventilation *
3 WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Do not use the seat heaters and the seat ventilation
even in LO when the engine is OFF. Under such
conditions, the battery may be weakened, making
the engine difficult to start.
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Rear Seat Heaters *
If the power mode is in ON: The HI setting
heats the seats faster than the LO setting.
There is no heater in the rear center seating
position.
3 WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Controls
While in HI, the heater cycles on and off.
u The appropriate indicator will be on
while the seat heater is on. Briefly press
the button on the opposite side to turn
the heater off. The indicator will be off.
When a comfortable temperature is
reached, select LO to keep the seat
warm.
1Rear Seat Heaters *
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
* Not available on all models
179
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that will as quickly as
possible, raise or lower the interior temperature to your preference.
Dashboard vents Dashboard and
floor vents
Controls
AUTO Button
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Dial
Floor vents
Floor and
defroster vents
/
(Fan Control) Buttons
Passenger’s Side
Temperature
Control Dial
(Recirculation) Button
A/C (Air Conditioning) Button
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Press the AUTO button.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver’s side or passenger’s side control
dial.
3. Press the
button to cancel.
■ Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Press the
button and switch the mode depending on environmental conditions.
Recirculation Mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh Air Mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
180
1Using Automatic Climate Control
If any buttons are pressed while using the climate
control system in AUTO, the function of the button
that was pressed will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the button that was pressed will be
controlled automatically.
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may not start immediately when the AUTO
button is pressed.
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on AUTO, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
Pressing the
button switches the climate
control system between on and off. When turned on,
the system returns to your last selection.
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Pressing the
button turns the air
conditioning system on and automatically
switches the system to fresh air mode.
Pressing the
button again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Press the
2. Press the
1To rapidly defrost the windows
button.
button.
Controls
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode.
If you keep the system in recirculation mode, the
windows may fog up from humidity. This impedes
visibility.
181
uuClimate Control SystemuSynchronized Mode
Synchronized Mode
1Synchronized Mode
When you press the
button, the system changes
to synchronized mode.
When the system is in dual mode, the driver side
temperature and the passenger side temperature can
be set separately.
Models with navigation system
Controls
In AUTO mode, the system adjusts each temperature
based on the information of the sunlight sensor and
the sun position updated by the navigation system’s
GPS.
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver side and the passenger
side in synchronized mode.
1. Press the SYNC button.
u The system will switch to synchronized mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using driver’s side temperature control dial.
Press the SYNC button to return to dual mode.
182
uuClimate Control SystemuAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Sensor
Controls
Sensor
183
184
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System *
About Your Audio System................ 186
USB Port .......................................... 187
Auxiliary Input Jack .......................... 187
Audio System Theft Protection ......... 188
Audio Remote Controls.................... 189
Audio System Basic Operation * ....... 190
Audio/Information Screen ................ 191
Wallpaper Setup .............................. 194
Display Setup ................................... 196
Adjusting the Sound ........................ 197
Playing the AM/FM Radio ................. 198
Playing the SiriusXM® Radio ............. 200
* Not available on all models
Playing a CD .................................... 202
Playing an iPod ................................ 205
Playing Pandora® ............................. 208
Playing a USB Flash Drive ................. 210
Playing Bluetooth® Audio................. 213
Audio Error Messages *..................... 215
General Information on the Audio
System *............................................ 218
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
Training HomeLink........................... 222
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® *
Using HFL ........................................ 224
HFL Menus....................................... 226
Compass * .......................................... 253
185
Audio System *
About Your Audio System
On models with navigation system, see Navigation System Manual for operation of
the audio system, AcuraLink, Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®, and voice commands for
these features.
The audio system features AM/FM radio and the SiriusXM® Radio service. It can also
play audio CDs, WMA/MP3/AAC files, iPod, iPhone, USB flash drives, and
Bluetooth® devices.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel, or
the remote controls on the steering wheel.
1About Your Audio System
SiriusXM® Radio is available on a subscription basis
only. For more information on SiriusXM® Radio,
contact a dealer.
2 General Information on the Audio System *
P. 218
SiriusXM® Radio is available in the United States and
Canada, except Hawaii, Alaska, and Puerto Rico.
SiriusXM® is a registered trademark of SiriusXM
Radio, Inc.
iPod
Features
Video CDs, DVDs, and 3-inch (8-cm) mini CDs are not
supported.
iPod, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.
USB Flash
Drive
Remote Control
186
* Not available on all models
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
uuAudio System * uUSB Port
USB Port
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the iPod dock connector or the USB
flash drive to the USB port.
1USB Port
• Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
•
•
•
Auxiliary Input Jack
If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer’s instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
Features
Use the jack to connect standard audio devices.
1. Open the AUX cover.
2. Connect a standard audio device to the
input jack using a 1/8 inch (3.5 mm) stereo
miniplug.
u The audio system automatically switches
to the AUX mode.
•
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a
hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard
disk drive, as the device or your files may be
damaged.
We recommend backing up your data before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
1Auxiliary Input Jack
To switch the mode, press any of the audio mode
buttons. You can return to the AUX mode by
pressing the AUX button.
You cannot use the auxiliary input jack if you replace
the audio system.
187
uuAudio System * uAudio System Theft Protection
Audio System Theft Protection
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the battery is disconnected or goes dead.
■ Reactivating the audio system
Features
188
1. Set the power mode to ON, and turn on the audio system.
u If you set the power mode to ACCESSORY, you will be requested to enter the
audio security code. See step 3.
2. Press and hold the power button again for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the system’s control unit recognizes that
the system is in your vehicle.
If the control unit fails to recognize, ENTER CODE appears on the audio/
information screen.
3. Enter the audio security code using the preset buttons. If you enter an incorrect
digit, continue to the last digit, then try again. If you do not enter the code
correctly after 10 tries, leave the system for one hour before trying again, or visit
a dealer to have the system reset.
1Audio System Theft Protection
U.S. models
Find the audio system’s security code and serial
number label in your owner’s manual kit.
We recommend that you write down the serial
number in this owner’s manual.
Do not store the label in your vehicle. If you lose the
label, you must first retrieve the serial number, and
then obtain the code.
You can find out about your serial number and
security code from a dealer.
You can register the security code at Acura Owners
(owners.acura.com.), and find information on how to
retrieve the serial number and obtain the code at
radio-navicode.acura.com.
uuAudio System * uAudio Remote Controls
Audio Remote Controls
Allows you to operate the audio system while driving.
MODE Button
MODE Button
Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
FM1 FM2 AM SiriusXM®1 SiriusXM®2
CD AUX
VOL
(Volume)
Button
CH
(Channel)
Button
Some sources will only appear when available, such
as when a CD is inserted or when a compatible device
is connected.
VOL Button
Press 3 : Increases the volume.
Press 4 : Decreases the volume.
Features
CH Button
• When listening to the radio
Press (+ : Selects the next preset radio station.
Press (- : Selects the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold (+ : Selects the next strong station.
Press and hold (- : Selects the previous strong station.
• When listening to a CD, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press (+ : Skips to the next song.
Press (- : Goes back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
• When listening to a CD or USB flash drive
Press and hold (+ : Skips to the next folder.
Press and hold (- : Goes back to the previous folder.
• When listening to Pandora® *
Press (+ : Skips to the next song.
Press and hold (+ : Selects the next station.
Press and hold (- : Selects the previous station.
* Not available on all models
1Audio Remote Controls
189
Audio System Basic Operation *
To use the audio system function, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Use the selector knob or SETUP button to
access some audio functions.
SETUP
Button
Press
to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
Features
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press
to set
your selection.
SETUP button: Press to select any mode such
as the RDS Information, Sound Settings, Play
Mode, Resume/Pause, or Adjust Clock.
BACK button: Press to go back to the
previous display.
button: Press to change the audio/
information screen brightness. The brightness
can be set differently for the day time and
night time.
Press once for the day time mode.
Press twice for the night time mode.
Adjust the brightness using
.
* Not available on all models
Press
to select.
to enter.
Press the MODE, (+ , (- , 3 or 4 button on the
steering wheel to change any audio setting.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 189
Selector
Knob
Menu Display
190
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
BACK
Button
Button
1Audio System Basic Operation *
Setup Menu Items
2 Radio Data System (RDS) P. 199
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 197
2 How to Select a Play Mode P. 204
2 To pause or resume a file P. 214
2 Setting the Clock P. 118
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays audio status and wallpaper. It allows you to go to various setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Press DISPLAY button. Rotate
modes. Press .
and select the mode from the three display
Features
DISPLAY
Button
Selector Knob
Continued
191
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio Display
Shows the current audio information.
2 Audio System Basic Operation * P. 190
■ Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 194
■ Minimum Display
Features
Minimizes the display by only showing the compass, audio status, and clock on the
display.
■ Setting Options
1. Press SETUP button.
2. Rotate
and select the setup option you
want to change. Press .
192
* Not available on all models
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uAudio/Information Screen
■ Language Selection
1. Rotate
to select Language Selection,
then press .
2. Rotate
to select the language, then
press .
Features
193
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uWallpaper Setup
Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
1Wallpaper Setup
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
Models with navigation system
See the navigation system manual for how to change the wallpaper.
•
■ Import Wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the port.
•
•
2 USB Port P. 187
Features
194
2. Press the SETUP button.
3. Rotate
to select Display Setup, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press
.
5. Rotate
to select Import, then press .
6. Rotate
to select a desired picture, then
press .
7. The preview of the imported data is
displayed.
8. Press
to save the data.
u The confirmation message will appear.
Then the display will return to the import
wallpaper list.
9. Rotate
to select the place to save the
data, then press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
•
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
Images between 1,680 x 936 (display’s maximum
image size) and 420 x 234 pixels in size can be
displayed in full screen.
The number of files that can be selected is up to
255.
Up to 64 characters can be displayed in the file
name.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures, No
compatible images were found. See Owner’s
Manual. will appear.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uWallpaper Setup
■ Select Wallpaper
1. Rotate
to select Select on the wallpaper setup menu, then press .
u The screen will change to the wallpaper list.
2. Rotate
to select desired wallpaper and press .
u The confirmation message will appear. Then the display will return to the
wallpaper setup menu.
■ Delete Wallpaper
.
Features
1. Rotate
to select Delete on the wallpaper setup menu, then press
u The screen will change to the delete wallpaper list.
2. Rotate
to select wallpaper that you want to delete and press .
u The confirmation message will appear.
3. Rotate
to select OK, then press
to delete completely.
u The confirmation message will appear.
195
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change brightness or color theme on the audio/information screen.
■ Brightness
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Display Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Brightness, then press
.
4. Rotate
to adjust the setting.
Features
■ Color Theme
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Display Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Color Theme, then
press . Rotate
to setting you want,
then press .
196
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
SETUP Button
Press the SETUP button, and rotate
to
select Sound Settings, then press . Rotate
to scroll through the following choices:
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: OFF, LOW, MID, and
HIGH.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
Selector Knob
Bass
Features
Treble
Fader
Balance
Subwoofer
Treble is selectable.
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
197
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying the AM/FM Radio
Playing the AM/FM Radio
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Features
CATEGORY Bar
Press either side to display and
select an RDS category.
FM/AM Button
Press to select a band.
SCAN Button
Press to sample each of the strongest
stations on the selected band for 10
seconds. To turn off scan, press the
button again.
198
SKIP Bar
Press to search up and down the
selected band for a station with a
strong signal.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it
until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a
band, then press the preset button.
BACK Buttons
Press to go back to the previous
display.
A.SEL (Auto Select) Button
Press to scan both bands and store
the strongest station in each
preset.To turn off auto select, press
the button again. This restores the
presets you originally set.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to tune the radio
frequency.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying the AM/FM Radio
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Playing the AM/FM Radio
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS capable FM station.
■ RDS information
1. Press the SETUP button and rotate
to
select RDS Information.
2. Each time you press , the RDS
Information switches between on and off.
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Pressing the MODE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 189
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset button memory. FM1 and FM2 let you
store six stations each.
■ To find an RDS station from your selected program category
RDS Category
1. Press the CATEGORY bar to display and
select an RDS category.
2. Use SKIP or SCAN to select an RDS station.
Features
A.SEL function scans and stores up to 6 AM stations
and 12 FM stations with a strong signal into the
preset button memory.
If you do not like the stations auto select has stored,
you can manually store your preferred frequencies.
199
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying the SiriusXM® Radio
Playing the SiriusXM® Radio
Features
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
(SiriusXM®) Button
Press to select SiriusXM® Radio.
CATEGORY Bar
Press either side to display and select
an SiriusXM® Radio category.
SCAN Button
Press to sample all channels (in the
channel mode), or channels within a
category (in the category mode).
Each sampling continues for a few
seconds. Press SCAN again to cancel
scanning and continue listening to the
channel.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
200
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a channel:
1. Tune to the selected channel.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it
until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored channel, select
SiriusXM®, then press the preset
button.
SKIP Bar
Press
or
to the
previous or next channel.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select channels.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying the SiriusXM® Radio
■ To Play the SiriusXM® Radio
1. Press the
button to select the SiriusXM® radio band (SiriusXM®1 or
SiriusXM®2).
2. Press the SETUP button, rotate
to select SiriusXM® Mode, and press .
Rotate
to select Channel Mode or Category Mode, then press .
3. Select a channel using the TUNE ( ), SKIP, CATEGORY, SCAN, or Preset
buttons.
■ To Select a Channel from a List
In the channel mode, all available channels are
selectable. In the category mode, you can select a
channel within a category (Jazz, Rock, Classical,
etc.).
You can store 12 SiriusXM® stations in the preset
buttons. SiriusXM®1 and SiriusXM®2 let you store 6
stations each.
There may be instances when SiriusXM® Radio does
not broadcast all the data fields (artist name, title).
This does not indicate a problem with your audio
system.
Features
1. Press
to display a channel list.
2. Rotate
to select a channel, then press
.
1Playing the SiriusXM® Radio
201
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or
AAC format. With the CD loaded, press the CD button.
Features
SCAN Button
You will get a 10-second sampling of
each song.
● Press to sample all tracks on the CD
(all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
● Press and hold to sample the first file
in each of the main folders (MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
● To turn off scan, press the button.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
CATEGORY Bar
Press (+ to skip to the next folder, and
(- to skip to the beginning of the
previous folder in MP3, WMA, or AAC.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
202
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the
CD slot.
CD Button
Press to play a CD.
SKIP Bar
Press
or
to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a track/file.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
Selector Knob
Turn to change tracks/files.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
(MP3/WMA)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
1. Press to switch the display to a folder list.
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
3. Press
to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press .
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Folder Selection
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Features
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
Track Selection
Continued
203
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a mode, then press .
Features
Play Mode
Items
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Normal Play, then press .
204
1How to Select a Play Mode
Press the BACK button to go back to the previous
display, and press the SETUP button to cancel this
setting mode.
Play Mode Menu Items
Normal Play
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current track/file(s).
Random All: Plays all tracks/files in random order.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then press the AUX
button.
2 USB Port P. 187
Album Art
USB Indicator
Comes on when an iPod is
connected.
Features
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
AUX Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
SKIP Bar
Press
or
to change songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
Continued
205
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a File from the iPod Menu
1. Press
to display the iPod menu.
2. Rotate
to select a menu.
3. Press
to display the items on that menu.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
Features
206
iPod® Menu
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 216
uuAudio System Basic Operation * u
■ How to Select a Play Mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a mode, then press .
Features
Play Mode
Items
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Off: Turns off the shuffle mode.
Shuffle: Plays all available files in a selected list
(playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres, or
composers) in random order.
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres,
or composers) in random order.
Repeat Off: Turns off the repeat mode.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current file.
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Normal Play, then press .
Continued
207
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying Pandora®
U.S. models
iPhone use only
Playing Pandora®
Activate Pandora®, and connect the iPhone using your dock connector to the USB
port, then press the AUX button.
2 USB Port P. 187
Rating Icon
Album Art
Features
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
AUX Button
Press to select iPhone (if connected
when the Pandora® application is
activated).
CATEGORY Bar
Press (+ to the next station.
Press (- to the previous station.
SKIP Bar
Press
to skip a song.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
Selector Knob
Press to enter PANDORA MENU.
Press and turn to select an item, then
press to set your selection.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
208
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying Pandora®
■ Pandora® Menu
1Playing Pandora®
You can operate some of the Pandora menu items from your vehicle’s audio system.
The available items are:
• Station List (QuickMix is also available)
• Like
• Dislike
• Resume/Pause
• SKIP
• Bookmark this song
• Bookmark this artist
Pandora® is a personalized Internet radio service that
selects music based on an artist, song, or genre a user
enters, and streams what is likely to be of interest.
To use this service in your vehicle, the Pandora® app
must first be installed on your iPhone. Visit
www.pandora.com. for more information.
If you cannot operate Pandora® through the audio
system, it may be streaming through Bluetooth®
Audio. Make sure Pandora® mode on your audio
system is selected.
1. Press
to display the PANDORA MENU.
2. Rotate
to select a menu.
3. Press
to display the items on that menu.
1Pandora® Menu
Available operating functions vary on software
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
Features
■ Operating a menu item
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 Pandora® P. 217
You can skip the song or select Dislike only a
predetermined number of times in an hour.
209
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the AUX button.
2 USB Port P. 187
USB Indicator
Comes on when a USB flash drive
is connected.
Features
CATEGORY Bar
Press (+ to skip to the next folder, and
(- to skip to the beginning of the
previous folder.
SCAN Button
You will get a 10-second sampling of
each file.
● Press to sample all files in the
current folder. To turn off scan,
press the button.
● Press and hold to sample the first file
in each of the main folders. To turn
off scan, press and hold the button.
BACK Button
Press to go back to the previous display.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
210
VOL/
(Power/volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
AUX Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
SKIP Bar
Press
or
to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly within
a file.
SETUP Button
Press to display menu items.
Selector Knob
Press and turn to select an item, then
press to set your selection.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1. Press to switch the display to a folder list.
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
3. Press
to change the display to a list of
files in that folder.
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press .
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System *
P. 218
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) are not played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 216
Features
Folder Selection
Track Selection
* Not available on all models
Continued
211
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and random modes when playing a file.
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a mode, then press .
Features
Play Mode
Items
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Normal Play, then press .
212
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Normal Play
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current file.
Repeat One Folder: Repeats all files in the current
folder.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current folder
in random order.
Random All: Plays all files in random order.
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and linked to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 231
Bluetooth Indicator
Comes on when
your phone is
connected to HFL.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
AUX Button
Press to select
Bluetooth® Audio.
SKIP Bar
Press
or
change files.
Preset 1 Button
Press to switch the
mode between
pause and resume.
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones:
• U.S.: Visit www.acura.com/handsfreelink, or call 1888-528-7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528-7876.
Features
VOL/
(Power/
volume) Knob
Press to turn the audio
system on and off.
Turn to adjust the
volume.
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
to
SETUP Button
Press to display
menu items.
Selector Knob
Press to display the
device’s name.
Continued
213
uuAudio System Basic Operation * uPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
linked to HFL.
2. Press the AUX button.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may be already linked.
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone manufacturer’s
operating instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack, you may need to press the AUX button
repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio system.
Features
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
■ To pause or resume a file
1. Press the SETUP button.
2. Rotate
to select Resume/Pause, then press .
Each time you press , the setting switches between Pause and Resume.
■ Switching to HFL
1Switching to HFL
Press the
(pick-up) button on the steering
wheel to receive a call when Bluetooth® Audio
is playing.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * P. 224
Button
Button
214
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
* Not available on all models
Press the
(hang-up) button to end the call
and return to Bluetooth® Audio.
If you receive a call while Bluetooth® Audio is in the
pause mode, it will resume play after ending the call.
Audio Error Messages *
CD Player
If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.
Error Message
Unplayable File
Bad Disc Please check
owners manual. Push Eject
Cause
Track/file format not supported
Solution
●
Current track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file
plays automatically.
●
Press the
(eject) button and remove the disc, and check that the
error message is cleared.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the
disc again.
Mechanical error
●
Mecha Error
2 Protecting CDs P. 220
●
Servo error
●
●
Check Disc
* Not available on all models
Disc error
●
Features
Bad Disc Please check
owners manual.
If the error message reappears, press the
button, and pull out
the disc.
Insert a different disc.
If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.
If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed,
contact a dealer.
Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed.
2 Protecting CDs P. 220
215
uuAudio Error Messages * uiPod/USB Flash Drive
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
USB Error
Solution
Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible with the
USB adapter unit.
Bad USB Device Please Check Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the audio system
Owners Manual.
off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Features
216
No Song
Appears when the iPod is empty. Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
Unsupported Ver
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is connected,
update the iPod software to the newer version.
Retry Connection
Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable File
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error message
appears for about 3 seconds, then plays the next song.
No Data
Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the USB flash
drive. Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
Unsupported
Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is
connected, reconnect the device.
uuAudio Error Messages * uPandora®
U.S. models
Pandora®
If an error occurs while playing Pandora®, you may see the following error messages.
If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
Appears when there is no station list on the device. Use the device to create a station.
PANDORA Requires Update
Appears when Pandora version is not supported. Please update the device application.
PANDORA Unavailable
Appears when Pandora is performing system maintenance. Try again later.
PANDORA Cannot Connect
Appears when Pandora is unable to play music. Check your device.
PANDORA Loading...
Appears when Pandora is loading.
Features
PANDORA No Station
217
General Information on the Audio System *
SiriusXM® Radio Service
■ Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
1. You need your radio ID ready before registering for subscription. To see the ID in
the display: Turn the selector knob until 0 appears.
2. Have your radio ID and credit card number ready, and either call or visit the
SiriusXM® website to subscribe.
■ Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
Press the
(SiriusXM®) button and stay in this mode for about 30 minutes
until the service is activated. Make sure your vehicle is in an open area with good
reception.
Features
218
■ SiriusXM® Radio Display Messages
Loading...:
SiriusXM® is loading the audio or program information.
Channel Off Air:
The channel is not currently broadcasting.
Channel Not Authorized:
SiriusXM® radio is receiving information update from the network.
No Signal:
The signal is too weak in the current location.
--------:
No such channel exists, the channel is not part of your subscription, or the artist or
title information is unavailable.
Check Antenna:
There is a problem with the SiriusXM® antenna. Contact a dealer.
* Not available on all models
1Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
Contact Information for SiriusXM® Radio:
US: SiriusXM® Radio at www.siriusxm.com or (800)
852-9696
Canada: SiriusXM® Canada at www.xmradio.ca, or
(877) 209-0079
1Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
The SiriusXM® satellites are in orbit over the equator;
therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause
satellite reception interruptions. Satellite signals are
more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and
mountains the farther north you travel from the
equator.
You may experience reception problems under the
following circumstances:
• In a location with an obstruction to the south of
your vehicle.
• In tunnels
• On the lower level of a multi-tiered road
• Large items carried on the roof rack
uuGeneral Information on the Audio System * uRecommended CDs
Recommended CDs
• Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labeled for audio use.
• Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
• Play only standard round-shaped CDs.
1Recommended CDs
A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded
under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not
play either.
The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
■ CDs with MP3, WMA or AAC files
Features
• Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
• Some versions of MP3, WMA or AAC formats may be unsupported.
Continued
219
uuGeneral Information on the Audio System * uRecommended CDs
■ Protecting CDs
Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:
• Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
• When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the center to the outside edge.
• Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
• Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
• Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
• Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
• Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.
1Protecting CDs
NOTICE
Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside
and damage the audio unit.
Examples:
●
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and
excessively thick CDs
Bubbled/
Wrinkled
With Label/
Sticker
Features
Sealed
●
●
With Plastic Ring
● Poor quality
Damaged CDs
CDs
Chipped/
Cracked
Small CDs
3-inch (8-cm) CD
220
Using
Printer Label
Kit
Warped
Burrs
uuGeneral Information on the Audio System * uCompatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Compatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
■ iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
Model
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano (1st to 7th generation*) *launch in 2012
iPod touch (1st to 5th generation*) *launch in 2012
iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4s/iPhone 5/iPhone 5s/iPhone 5c
•
•
•
•
•
Use a recommended USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
1USB Flash Drives
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
Features
■ USB Flash Drives
1iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
221
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver can be programmed to operate up to three
remote controlled devices around your home, such as garage doors, lighting, or
home security systems.
■ Important Safety Precautions
Refer to the safety information that came with your garage door opener to test that
the safety features are functioning properly. If you do not have the safety
information, contact the manufacturer.
Before programming HomeLink, make sure that people and objects are out of the
way of the garage or gate to prevent potential injury or damage.
Features
When programming a garage door opener, park just outside the garage door’s
path.
Training HomeLink
Red Indicator
222
If you have not trained any of the buttons in
HomeLink before, you should erase any
previously learned codes. To do this:
• Press and hold the two outside buttons for
about 20 seconds, until the red indicator
blinks. Release the buttons, and proceed to
step 1.
• If you are training the second or third
button, go directly to step 1.
1HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
HomeLink® is a registered trademark of Gentex
Corporation.
Before programming HomeLink to operate a garage
door opener, confirm that the opener has an external
entrapment protection system, such as an “electronic
eye,” or other safety and reverse stop features. If it
does not, HomeLink may not be able to operate it.
uuHomeLink® Universal TransceiveruTraining HomeLink
■ Training a Button
1Training HomeLink
1. Position the remote transmitter you wish to link 1 to 3 inches (3 - 8 cm) from the
HomeLink button you want to program.
2. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button and the button on
the remote transmitter. Does the HomeLink indicator (LED)
blink after 10 secs?
NO
YES
Retraining a Button
If you want to retrain a programmed button for a
new device, you do not have to erase all button
memory. You can replace the existing memory code
using this procedure:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button
until the HomeLink indicator begins to blink.
NO
Standard transmitter
YES
YES
a. Press and hold the remote and the HomeLink
button at the same time. Then, while
continuing to hold the HomeLink button,
press and release the button on the remote
every 2 secs.
Does the LED blink within 20 secs?
NO
4. Press and hold the HomeLink button again.
Training
Complete
HomeLink LED
is on.
5. Press and hold the HomeLink
button again.
The remote-controlled device
should operate.
Training Complete
HomeLink indicator blinks for 2 secs,
then remains on.
a. The remote has a rolling code. Press the
“learn” button on the remote-controlled
device (e.g. garage door opener).
Indicator remains on
for about 25 secs.
Rolling code transmitter
Indicator blinks rapidly for
2 secs, then remains on for
about 23 secs.
2. Continue to hold the HomeLink button and
follow steps 1 - 3 under “Training a Button.”
Features
3. Press and hold the
programmed HomeLink
button for about a sec.
Does the device (garage
door opener) work?
Erasing Codes
To erase all the codes, press and hold the two outside
buttons until the HomeLink indicator begins to blink
(about 10 to 20 secs). You should erase all codes
before selling the vehicle.
If you have any problems, see the device’s
instructions, visit www.homelink.com, or call
HomeLink at (800) 355-3515.
b. Within 30 secs, press and hold the
programmed HomeLink button for 2 secs.
223
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® *
Models with navigation system
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® *
For models with navigation system, see Navigation System Manual for how to
operate Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®.
Models without navigation system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Using HFL
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
■ HFL Buttons
Features
Volume up
Microphone
Pick-up Button
Hang-up Button
Volume down
Talk Button
Back Button
PHONE Button
Selector Knob
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up) button: Press to end a call.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Back) button: Press to cancel a command.
PHONE button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate
to select an item on the screen, then press
224
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities:
• U.S.: Visit www.acura.com/handsfreelink, or call 1888-528-7876.
• Canada: Visit www.handsfreelink.ca, or call 1-888528-7876.
* Not available on all models
.
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• Press and release the
button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag. Speak
clearly and naturally after a beep.
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system’s
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
Bluetooth Indicator
Comes on when your
phone is connected to HFL.
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® *
The audio/information screen notifies you
when there is an incoming call.
Roam Status
Signal Strength
Battery Level Status
HFL Mode
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
Call Name
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Features
1HFL Status Display
You can change the system language to English,
French, or Spanish.
2 Language Selection P. 193
Certain manual functions are disabled or
inoperable while the vehicle is in motion. You
cannot select a grayed-out option until the
vehicle is stopped.
Disabled Option
* Not available on all models
Only previously stored speed dial entries with
voice tags can be called using the talk button
while the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 241
225
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON to use HFL.
PHONE or
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
PHONE
Speed Dial*1 Display your speed dial entry lists.
(up to 15 entries per paired phone)
Call History*1
Features
Dialed Calls
Display the last 20
outgoing calls.
Received Calls
Display the last 20
incoming calls.
Missed Calls
Display the last 20
missed calls.
Phonebook*1 Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Dial*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
226
Some functions are limited while driving. A message
appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving
and the operation is canceled.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
Redial*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Select message and
Text Message
.
Message is read aloud
Read/Stop reading System reads received message aloud, or
Features
stop message from being read.
Reply
Call
Display Message
Reply to a received message using one of
six fixed phrases.
Make a call to the sender.
See an entire received message
(if more than three lines of text).
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Continued
227
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
Phone Setup
Connection
Add a New Phone Pair a phone to the system.
Connect a Phone
Connect a phone to the system.
Features
Disconnect Phone Disconnect a paired phone from the
system.
228
Delete a Phone
Delete a previously paired phone.
Pairing Code
Create a code for a paired phone.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
Add New
Speed Dial*1
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the
phonebook to store as a speed dial
number.
Call History
Select a phone number from the call
history to store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Change Speed Dial Change a previously stored speed dial
number.
Features
Existing entry list
Enter a phone number to store as a
speed dial number.
Delete Speed Dial Delete a previously stored speed dial
number.
Store Voice Tag
Create a voice tag for a speed dial
number.
Change Voice Tag Change a voice tag for a speed dial
number.
Delete Voice Tag
Delete a voice tag for a speed dial
number.
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Continued
229
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
Auto Transfer
Caller ID Info
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when you
enter the vehicle.
Name Priority
Number Priority
Features
Passcode*1
Prioritize the caller’s name as the
caller ID.
Prioritize the caller’s phone number as
the caller ID.
Create a security PIN for a paired phone.
Text Message Notice Turn incoming text message notifications on or off.
System Clear
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
230
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries, and security
codes.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a cell phone (when there is no
Continued
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
paired to HFL.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
Features
phone paired to the system)
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone doesn’t appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
5. HFL gives you a four-digit pairing code to
input on your phone.
When your phone prompts you, input the
four-digit pairing code.
6. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
231
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To pair a cell phone (when a phone has
Features
232
already been paired to the system)
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
u If a prompt appears asking to connect to
a phone, select No and proceed with
step 2.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Connection, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Add a New Phone,
then press .
u The screen changes to Select Location.
5. Rotate
to select Empty, then press .
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
6. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth device.
7. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone doesn’t appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
8. HFL gives you a four-digit pairing code to
input on your phone.
When your phone prompts you, input the
four-digit pairing code.
9. You will receive a notification on the screen
if pairing is successful.
233
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Connection, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Pairing Code, then
press .
5. Rotate
to select Fixed or Random, then
press .
Features
234
1To change the pairing code setting
The default pairing code is “0000” until you change
the setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
Continued
Features
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Connection, then Delete a Phone.
3. Rotate
to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
4. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
u You will receive a notification on the
screen if it is successful.
235
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To Set Up a Message Notice Option
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Message Notice, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
Features
236
1To Set Up a Message Notice Option
On: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new text message.
Off: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To Create a Security PIN
1To Create a Security PIN
Continued
In the phone is already security PIN protected, you
need to enter the current security PIN before clearing
the PIN or creating a new one.
Features
You can protect each of the six cell phones with a security PIN.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select
Passcode.
3. Select a phone you want to add a security
PIN to.
u Rotate
to select a phone you want to
add a security PIN to, then press .
4. You will receive a confirmation message on
the screen.
u Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
5. Enter a new four-digit number.
u Rotate
to select, then press . Press
to delete. Press
to enter the
security PIN.
6. Re-enter the four-digit number.
u The screen returns to the screen in step
2.
237
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Transferring
If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, the call can be automatically
transferred to HFL.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Auto
Transfer.
3. Rotate
to select On, then press .
4. You will receive a notification on the screen
if the change is successful.
Features
■ Caller’s ID Information
You can select a caller’s information to be displayed when you have an incoming
call.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Caller ID
Info.
3. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
4. You will receive a notification on the screen
if the change is successful.
238
1Caller’s ID Information
Name Priority mode: A caller’s name is displayed if
it is stored in the phonebook.
Number Priority mode: A caller’s phone number is
displayed.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To Clear the System
Continued
Features
Security codes, paired phones, all stored voice tags, all speed dial entries, and all
imported phonebook data are erased.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select System
Clear.
3. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
4. You will receive a notification message on
the screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
5. You will receive a notification message on
the screen. Rotate
to finish.
239
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are
automatically imported to HFL.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Features
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Message
Work
Other
Pager
Voice
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
240
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Continued
You can use the audio preset buttons during a call to
store a speed dial number:
1. Press and hold the desired audio preset button
during a call.
2. The contact information for the active call will be
stored for the corresponding speed dial.
When a voice tag is stored, press the
call the number using the voice tag.
button to
Features
Up to 15 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Speed
Dial, then Add New.
3. Rotate
to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
By Phonebook:
u Select a number from the linked cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
By Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
By Phone Number:
u Input the number manually.
4. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Rotate
to select Yes or No,
then press .
5. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
say the name for the speed dial entry.
241
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Speed
Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
4. Rotate
to select Store Voice Tag, then
press .
5. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
Features
■ To delete a voice tag
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Speed
Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
4. Rotate
to select Delete Voice Tag,
then press .
u You will receive a confirmation message
on the screen. Rotate
to select Yes,
then press .
242
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To delete a speed dial number
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
u Repeat the procedure to select Speed
Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
4. Rotate
to select Delete Speed Dial,
then press .
u You will receive a confirmation message
on the screen. Rotate
to select Yes,
then press .
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
Features
■ Making a Call
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 30 feet (10 meters).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Continued
243
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
Features
phonebook
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook are automatically imported to
HFL.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phonebook, then press
.
3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Rotate
to select the initial, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a name, then press .
5. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select
, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
244
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using the talk button.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 225
2 Speed Dial P. 241
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using the talk button.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 225
2 Speed Dial P. 241
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Redial, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using the call history
Continued
1To make a call using the call history
The call history displays the last 20 dialed, received, or
missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.)
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
Features
Call history is stored by Dialed Calls,
Received Calls, and Missed Calls.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Call History, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Dialed Calls, Received
Calls, or Missed Calls, then press .
4. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
On the Phone screen, the first six speed dials on the
list can be directly selected by pressing the
corresponding audio preset buttons (1-6).
Select More Speed Dial Lists to view another paired
phone’s speed dial list. You can make a call from that
list using the currently connected phone.
When a voice tag is stored, press the
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 241
button to
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
245
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
HFL Mode
Caller Name
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming Call screen appears.
Press the
button to answer the call.
Press the
button to decline or end the call.
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold
to answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Ignore the incoming call if you do not want to answer
it.
Press the
current call.
Features
246
button if you want to hang up the
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
Continued
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
Features
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer Call: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menudriven phone system.
1. To view the available options, press the
PHONE button.
2. Rotate
to select the option, then press
.
u The check box is checked when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
247
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Text Message
Features
248
HFL can display newly received text messages as well as 20 of the most recently
received messages on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be read aloud
and replied to using a fixed common phrase.
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text message.
2. Rotate
to select Yes to listen to the
message, then press .
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading out
the message.
3. To discontinue the message read-out, press
the BACK button.
1Receiving a Text Message
Not all phones are compatible with this feature.
Check handsfreelink.com for a list of compatible
phones.
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
With some phones, you may be able to display upto
20 most recent text messages.
Only the first three lines of the received message are
displayed with this option.
2 Displaying an entire message P. 252
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text
message feature. Only use the text message feature
when conditions allow you to do so safely.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Displaying Messages
1Displaying Messages
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Text Message, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
The
icon appears next to an unread message.
Only the first three lines of the received message are
displayed with this option.
2 Displaying an entire message P. 252
If you delete a message on the phone, the message is
also deleted in the system. If you send a message
from the system, the message goes to your phone’s
outbox.
Features
Continued
249
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Using the stop reading or read option
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Text Message, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading the
message aloud.
4. Press
to enter the Text Message Menu.
5. Rotate
to select Stop Reading or Read,
then press .
Features
250
1Using the stop reading or read option
This option changes to:
• Stop Reading while the text message is read out.
Select this option to discontinue the message readout.
• Read when you go to the Text Message menu, or
after you selected Stop Reading. Select this option
to hear the system reading out the selected
message.
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Reply to a message
Continued
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
• Talk to you later, I’m driving.
• I am on my way.
• I’m running late.
• OK
• Yes
• No
You cannot add, edit, or delete reply messages.
After you reply, the following is displayed:
Features
You can reply to a message using one of the
six common phrases available in the system.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Text Message, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading out
the message.
4. Press
to enter the Text Message Menu.
5. Rotate
to select Reply, then press .
6. Rotate
to select the reply message, then
press .
7. The reply message you selected is displayed.
Select Yes to send the message.
251
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink® * uHFL Menus
■ Making a call to a sender
Features
252
You can call the text message sender.
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select to Text Message, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading out
the message.
4. Press
to enter the Text Message Menu.
5. Rotate
to select Call, then press .
u HFL begins dialing.
■ Displaying an entire message
1. Press the PHONE button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select to Text Message, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select a message, then press
.
u The text message is displayed. The
system automatically starts reading out
the message.
4. Press
to enter the Text Message Menu.
5. Rotate
to select Display Message,
then press .
6. Rotate
to scroll down and display the
entire message.
Compass *
When you set the power mode to ON, the compass self-calibrates, and the compass
display appears.
Compass Calibration
If the compass indicates the wrong direction, or the CAL. indicator blinks, you need
to manually calibrate the system.
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press and hold the SETUP button until the
display shows the compass setting menu.
3. Rotate
to select Calibration, then press
.
1Compass *
Compass operation can be affected under the
following conditions:
• Driving near power lines or stations
• Crossing a bridge
• Passing a large vehicle, or driving near a large
object that can cause a magnetic disturbance
• When accessories such as antennas and roof racks
are mounted by magnets
1Compass Calibration
Calibrate the compass in an open area.
Compass Setting Menu Items
Features
While setting the compass:
• The BACK button returns to the previous screen.
• The SETUP button cancels the setting mode.
4. When the display changes to Calibration
Start, press .
5. Drive the vehicle slowly in two circles.
u The compass starts to show a direction
after the calibration. The CAL. indicator
goes off.
* Not available on all models
253
uuCompass * uCompass Zone Selection
Compass Zone Selection
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press and hold the SETUP button until the
display shows the compass setting menu.
3. Rotate
to select Zone, then press .
The display shows the current zone
number.
4. Rotate
to select the zone number of
your area (See Zone Map), then press .
Zone Number
Zone Map
2
15
Features
14
3
4
12
5
Guam Island: Zone 8
Puerto Rico: Zone 11
254
13
6
7 8
9
10 11
1Compass Zone Selection
The zone selection is done to compensate the
variation between magnetic north and true north.
If the calibration starts while the audio system is in
use, the display returns to normal after the calibration
is completed.
Driving
This chapter discusses driving, refueling, and information on items such as accessories.
Before Driving................................... 256
Towing a Trailer................................ 261
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ..... 266
When Driving
Starting the Engine .......................... 268
Precautions While Driving................. 273
Automatic Transmission ................... 274
Shifting ............................................ 275
Cruise Control * ................................ 279
Front Sensor Camera * ...................... 282
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) * ....... 284
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) * ...... 293
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System ........... 305
Blind spot information (BSI) System * .... 307
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent Control
System * .....................................................310
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)... 310
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation ......... 312
Braking
Brake System ................................... 314
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ........... 316
Brake Assist System.......................... 317
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) * ..................................... 318
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped ................................ 326
Parking Sensor System * ................... 327
Cross Traffic Monitor * ..................... 331
Multi-View Rear Camera.................. 334
Refueling
Fuel Information .............................. 335
How to Refuel ................................. 336
Fuel Economy.................................... 337
Accessories and Modifications ........ 338
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) * ..... 297
* Not available on all models
255
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
■ Exterior Checks
• Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
• Make sure the hood is securely closed.
u If the hood opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
• Make sure the tires are in good condition.
u Check air pressures, and check for damage and excessive wear.
Driving
256
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 370
• Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
1Exterior Checks
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the hood, causing a
fire. If you’ve parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal.
Also check under the hood for leftover flammable
materials after you or someone else has performed
maintenance on your vehicle.
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
■ Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
• Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle’s
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 259
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 128
• Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
Driving
• Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
• Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
• If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
• Securely close and lock all doors and the tailgate.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area or tow a trailer, have
the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified
technician.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 162
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 164
• Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 158
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 159
Continued
257
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
• Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver’s ability to operate the pedals, the operation
of the seats, or the operation of the sensors under the seats.
• Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 32
• Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 66
Driving
258
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Maximum Load Limit
The maximum load for your vehicle is 870 lbs (395 kg).
See Tire and Loading Information label attached to the driver’s doorjamb.
1Maximum Load Limit
3 WARNING
Overloading or improper loading
can affect handling and stability
and cause a crash in which you
can be hurt or killed.
Label Example
Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this manual.
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and
accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit -
Continued
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle axle.
2 Specifications P. 426
Driving
(1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your
vehicle’s placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers
that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount
equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in
your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs.
(1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all accessories, all cargo, and the tongue
load.
2 Specifications P. 426
259
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the
available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will
be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to
determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage
load capacity of your vehicle.
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants,
accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
Load Limits Example
Driving
Example1
Max Load
870 lbs
(395 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs
(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
570 lbs (259 kg)
Max Load
870 lbs
(395 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs
(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
120 lbs (55 kg)
Example2
260
Towing a Trailer
Towing Preparation
■ Towing Load Limits
1Towing Load Limits
Your vehicle can tow a trailer if you carefully observe the load limits, use the proper
equipment, and follow the towing guidelines. Check the load limits before driving.
■ Total trailer weight
Maximum allowable weight of the trailer,
cargo, and everything in or on it must not
exceed 1,500 lbs (680 kg). Towing loads in
excess of this can seriously affect vehicle
handling and performance and can damage
the engine and drivetrain.
Total Load
■ Tongue load
Continued
Exceeding any load limit or improperly
loading your vehicle and trailer can cause a
crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Check the loading of your vehicle and
trailer carefully before starting to drive.
Check if all loads are within limits at a public scale.
If a public scale is not available, add the estimated
weight of your cargo load to the weight of your
trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer), and the
tongue load.
Break-in Period
Avoid towing a trailer during your vehicle’s first 600
miles (1,000 km).
Driving
Tongue Load
Load
Tongue
The weight of the tongue with a fully loaded
trailer on the hitch should be approximately
10% of the total trailer weight.
• Excessive tongue load reduces front tire
traction and steering control. Too little
tongue load can make the trailer unstable
and cause it to sway.
• To achieve a proper tongue load, start by
loading 60% of the load toward the front
of the trailer and 40% toward the rear.
Readjust the load as needed.
3 WARNING
Never exceed the gross weight ratings.
Gross weight information
2 Vehicle Specifications P. 426
261
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Towing Equipment and Accessories
Towing equipment varies by the size of your trailer, how much load you are towing,
and where you are towing.
■ Hitches
The hitch must be of an approved type and properly bolted to the underbody.
■ Safety chains
Always use safety chains when you tow a trailer. Leave enough slack to allow the
trailer to turn corners easily, but do not allow the chains to drag on the ground.
■ Trailer brakes
Driving
Recommended for any trailer with a total weight of 1,000 lbs (450 kg) or more:
There are two common types of trailer brakes: surge and electric. Surge brakes are
common for boat trailers, since the brakes will get wet. If you choose electric brakes,
be sure they are electronically actuated. Do not attempt to attach trailer brakes to
your vehicle’s hydraulic system, as it will lower braking effectiveness and create a
potential hazard.
■ Additional towing equipment
Many states and provinces/territories require special outside mirrors when towing a
trailer. Even if mirrors are not required in your locale, you should install special
mirrors if visibility is restricted in any way.
262
1Towing Equipment and Accessories
Make sure that all equipment is properly installed and
maintained, and that it meets federal, state, province/
territory, and local regulations.
Consult your trailer sales or rental agency if any other
items are recommended or required for your towing
situation.
The lighting and wiring of trailers can vary by type
and brand. If a connector is required, it should only
be installed by a qualified technician.
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Trailer light
Trailer lights and equipment must comply with federal, state, province/territory, and
local regulations. Check with your local trailer sales or rental agency for the
requirements in the area where you plan to tow.
Grand (Black)
Left Turn Signal (Yellow)
Right Turn Signal (Brown)
Small (Red)
Option (Pink)
Stop Light (Light Green)
When using a non-Acura trailer lighting harness and converter, get the connector
and pins for your vehicle from a dealer.
Driving
Your trailer lighting connector is located behind the left side panel in the cargo area.
Each pin’s purpose and wiring color code are shown in the image.
263
uuTowing a TraileruDriving Safely with a Trailer
Driving Safely with a Trailer
■ Things You Need To Know Before Towing a Trailer
• Have the trailer properly serviced and keep it in good condition.
• Make sure that all the weights and load in the vehicle and trailer are within limits.
2 Towing Load Limits P. 261
• Securely attach the hitch, safety chains, and other necessary parts to the trailer.
• Securely store all the items in and on the trailer so that they do not shift while
driving.
• Check if the lights and brakes on the trailer are working properly.
• Check the pressures of the trailer tires, including the spare.
■ Towing Speeds and Gears
Driving
• Drive slower than normal.
• Obey posted speed limits for vehicles with trailers.
• Use the (D position when towing a trailer on level roads.
■ Turning and Braking
• Turn more slowly and with a wider turning arc than normal.
• Allow more time and distance for braking.
• Do not brake or turn suddenly.
■ Driving in Hilly Terrain
• Monitor your temperature gauge. If it nears the red (Hot) mark, turn off the
climate control system and reduce speed. Pull to the side of the road safely to cool
down the engine if necessary.
• Shift to the (S position if the transmission shifts frequently.
264
1Driving Safely with a Trailer
Operating speed when towing a trailer is restricted
up to 100km/h.
Parking
In addition to the normal precautions, place wheel
chocks at each of the trailer’s tires.
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Your Vehicle
Towing Your Vehicle
Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motor home. If your vehicle needs
to be towed in an emergency, refer to the emergency towing information.
2 Emergency Towing P. 423
Driving
265
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
General Information
Your vehicle has been designed primarily for use on pavement, however, its higher
ground clearance allows you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads. It is not
designed for trail-blazing, or other challenging off-road activities.
If you decide to drive on unpaved roads, you will find that it requires somewhat
different driving skills and that your vehicle will handle somewhat differently than it
does on pavement. Pay attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and get
acquainted with your vehicle before leaving the pavement.
Important Safety Precautions
To avoid loss of control or rollover, be sure to follow all precautions and
recommendations:
• Be sure to store cargo properly and do not exceed your cargo load limits.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 259
Driving
266
• Whenever you drive, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
• Keep your speed low, and never go faster than the conditions allow.
• It’s up to you to continually assess the situation and drive within the limits.
1Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
3 WARNING
Improperly operating this vehicle on or off
pavement can cause a crash or rollover in
which you and your passengers can be
seriously injured or killed.
• Follow all instructions and guidelines in
this owner’s manual.
• Keep your speed low, and don’t drive
faster than conditions permit.
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 26
2 Precautions While Driving P. 273
uuOff-Highway Driving GuidelinesuAvoiding Trouble
Avoiding Trouble
Driving
• Check Out Your Vehicle before you leave the pavement and make sure that all
scheduled maintenance has been completed. Pay special attention to the
condition of the tires, and check the tire pressures.
• Remember the route you choose presents limits (too steep or bumpy), you have
limits (driving skill and comfort), and your vehicle has limits (traction, stability, and
power). Failing to recognize these limits will likely put you and your passengers in
a hazardous situation.
• Accelerating and Braking should be done slowly and gradually. Trying to start
or stop too fast can cause a loss of traction and you could lose control.
• Avoiding Obstacles and Debris in the road reduces the likelihood of a rollover
or damage to your suspension or other components.
• Driving on Slopes increases your risk of a rollover, particularly if you attempt to
drive across a slope that is too steep. Going straight up or down a slope is usually
the safest. If you can’t clearly see all conditions or obstacles on a slope, walk it
before you drive it. If there is any doubt whether you can safely pass, don’t try it.
Find another route. If you get stuck when climbing, do not try to turn around.
Back down slowly following the same route you took up the hill.
• Crossing a Stream - Avoid driving through deep water. If you encounter water
in your route (a small stream or large puddle, for example), evaluate it carefully
before going ahead. Make sure it is shallow, flowing slowly, and has firm ground
underneath. If you are not sure of the depth or the ground, turn around and find
another route. Driving through deep water can also damage your vehicle. The
water can get into the transmission and differential, diluting the lubricant and
causing an eventual failure. It can also wash the grease out of the wheel bearings.
• If You Get Stuck, carefully go in the direction that you think will get you
unstuck. Do not spin the tires as this will only make things worse and could
damage the transmission. If you are unable to free yourself, your vehicle will need
to be towed. Front and rear tow hooks are provided for this purpose.
267
When Driving
Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
1Starting the Engine
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in thinner
air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet (2,400 meters).
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system, and rear defogger in order to reduce
battery drain.
Brake Pedal
2. Check that the shift lever is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Driving
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
268
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. If temperatures consistently
below -22°F (-30°C) are expected, the coolant
mixture should be changed to a higher concentration
to prevent freezing. Consult a dealer for details.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
Bring the keyless access remote close to the ENGINE
START/STOP button if the battery in the keyless
access remote is weak.
2 If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is
Weak P. 409
The engine may not start if the keyless access remote
is subjected to strong radio waves.
You do not need to hold the ENGINE START/STOP
button to start the engine.
If the engine does not start, wait at least 10 seconds
before trying again.
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Stopping the Engine
1Starting the Engine
You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
1. Shift to (P .
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button with your foot on the brake pedal.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft. If an improperly coded key (or other device) is
used, the engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 137
Driving
Continued
269
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Remote Engine Start with Vehicle Feedback *
You can remotely start the engine using the two-way keyless access remote from
extended distances.
■ To start the engine
With the doors locked, Press the
button,
then press and hold the
button.
Go within the range,
and try again.
Amber LED: Blinks when any button is pressed.
Continues to blink
during a vehicle
self check until the
engine starts.
Driving
Green LED: Comes on while
the engine is running.
Red LED: Blinks when the
remote is out of the keyless
access system range.
The engine runs for up to 10 minutes without you starting the vehicle.
To extend the run time for another 10 minutes during the first run, press the
button, then press and hold the
button.
u The amber LED blinks, then the green LED comes back on if a 10-minute
extension request was transmitted successfully.
After pressing the (lock) button, wait for the green LED to blink. This indicates that
the all the doors and the tailgate are locked.
270
* Not available on all models
1Remote Engine Start with Vehicle Feedback *
3 WARNING
Engine exhaust contains toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing carbon monoxide can kill you or
cause unconsciousness.
Never use the remote engine starter when
the vehicle is parked in a garage or other
area with limited ventilation.
If there are buildings and obstacles between your
vehicle and the remote, the range will be reduced.
This distance may vary by external electrical
interference.
The engine may not start by the remote engine start
if:
• You have disabled a remote engine start setting
using the multi-information display.
• The power mode is not in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
• The shift lever is in a position other than (P .
• The hood is open, or any door or the tailgate is
unlocked.
• You have already used the remote twice to start
the engine.
• Another registered keyless access remote is in the
vehicle.
• There is any antenna failure.
• Door is unlocked with the built-in key.
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ To stop the engine
Press and hold the
for one second.
Amber LED: Blinks when any
button is pressed.
1Remote Engine Start with Vehicle Feedback *
button
Red LED:
Comes on for one second to let you
know that the engine has stopped.
Before starting the engine, make sure to check the
door lock status using the remote. When you press
the
button, wait for the green LED to blink. If
the red LED turns on, the doors and tailgate did not
lock, and the engine does not start.
●
●
While the engine is running, the vehicle will
automatically precondition inside the vehicle.
When it is warm outside:
• The air conditioning is activated in recirculation
mode.
When it is cold outside:
• The defroster is activated at a moderately warm
temperature.
• The rear defogger and door mirror heaters are
activated.
Blinks when the remote is out of
the keyless access system range.
The engine will not stop.
Continued
Driving
* Not available on all models
• The engine oil pressure is low.
• The engine coolant temperature is extremely high.
• The telematics unit malfunctions.
• The security system alarm is not set.
Go within the range,
and try again.
271
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Starting to Drive
When the engine was started using the two-way keyless access remote *
1. Depress the brake pedal and press the ENGINE START/STOP button
simultaneously.
When the engine was started in any case
1Starting to Drive
When the engine was started using the two-way keyless
access remote *
The engine stops when the shift lever is moved out of
(P before the ENGINE START/STOP button is
pressed. Follow the step 1 when starting to drive.
2. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, release the parking brake. Check that
the parking brake indicator has gone off.
2 Parking Brake P. 314
3. Put the shift lever in (D . Select (R when reversing.
4. Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to pull
away.
■ Hill start assist system
Driving
272
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
will not operate on small inclines.
Move the shift lever to (D or (S when facing uphill, or (R when facing downhill,
then release the brake pedal.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Precautions While Driving
■ Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
• Take corners at slower speeds than you would with a passenger vehicle.
• Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers whenever possible.
• Do not modify your vehicle in any way that you would raise the center of gravity.
• Never carry more than 165 lbs (75 kg) of cargo on the roof rack (Acura accessory).
■ In Rain
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine,
driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
■ Other Precautions
NOTICE
Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the transmission.
NOTICE
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel on the
full left or right position for a while, the electric power
steering (EPS) system heats up. The system goes into a
protective mode, and limits its performance. The
steering wheel becomes harder and harder to operate.
Once the system cools down, the EPS system is restored.
Repeated operation under these conditions can
eventually damage the system.
If the power mode is set to ACCESSORY while
driving, the engine will shut down and all steering
and brake power assist functions will stop, making it
difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not put the shift lever in (N , as you will lose
engine braking (and acceleration) performance.
Driving
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
1Precautions While Driving
During the first 600 miles (1,000 km) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as not to damage the engine or powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km). You
should also follow this when the brake pads are replaced.
1Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 26
273
uuWhen DrivinguAutomatic Transmission
Automatic Transmission
■ Creeping
The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
■ Kickdown
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the
transmission to drop to a lower gear, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed. Depress
the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.
Driving
274
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
1Shifting
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in (P .
■ Shift lever positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Release Button
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting gears in extremely low temperatures (22°F/-30°C), there may be a short delay before the
shift indicated in the display. Always confirm you are
in the correct gear before driving.
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Used when idling
Driving
Drive
Used:
● For normal driving (gear change
between 1st and 6th automatically)
● When temporally driving in the
sequential mode
Drive (S)
Used:
● For automatically changing gears
between 1st and 6th (6th gear is used
only at high speed)
● When driving in the sequential mode
Continued
275
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Models without
full color display
Shift Lever Position Indicator
(M (Sequential Shift mode) Indicator/
Gear Position Indicator
Tachometer’s red zone
Driving
Depress the brake pedal and press
the shift lever release button to shift.
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
276
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
Whichever position the shift lever is in when driving,
a blinking transmission indicator indicates a
transmission problem.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer’s red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Sequential Shift Mode
Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 6th gears without removing your
hands from the steering wheel. The transmission will switch to the sequential shift
mode.
■ When the shift lever is in (D :
The vehicle will go into the sequential shift mode momentarily, and the gear position
indicator will come on.
Once you start traveling at a constant speed, the sequential shift mode will
automatically switch off, and the gear position indicator will go off.
Hold the (+ paddle shifter for two seconds to return to normal drive.
The vehicle will go into the sequential shift mode, and the M (sequential shift mode)
indicator and gear position indicator will come on. At speeds of 6 mph (10 km/h) or
less, the vehicle automatically shifts down into 1st gear. It will not automatically shift
up, even if vehicle speed increases.
Driving
■ When the shift lever is in (S :
You can only pull away in 1st or 2nd gear.
When switching out of the sequential shift mode, move the shift lever from (S to
(D . When the sequential shift mode is canceled, the M indicator and gear position
indicator go off.
Continued
277
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Second gear lock mode
If you pull the (+ paddle shifter while stopped or driving at 6 mph (10 km/h) or less,
the gear position will be locked in 2nd gear. This makes it easier to pull away on
slippery surfaces such as snow covered roads.
To cancel the 2nd gear lock mode, pull the (- paddle shifter, or move the shift lever
from (S to (D .
■ Sequential Shift Mode Operation
(- Paddle Shifter
(Shift down)
1Sequential Shift Mode Operation
(+ Paddle Shifter
(Shift up)
Driving
Recommended Shift Points
Use this table as a guideline for efficient fuel
economy and effective emission control.
Downshifting when
pulling the (- paddle
shifter.
(Changes to a lower
gear.)
278
Each paddle shift operation makes a single gear
change.
To change gears continuously, release the paddle
shifter before pulling it again for the next gear.
Upshifting when pulling
the (+ paddle shifter.
(Changes to a higher
gear.)
Shift Up
1st to 2nd
2nd to 3rd
3rd to 4th
4th to 5th
5th to 6th
Normal Acceleration
15 mph (24 km/h)
25 mph (40 km/h)
40 mph (64 km/h)
45 mph (72 km/h)
50 mph (80 km/h)
The gear position indicator blinks when you cannot
shift up or down. It indicates that your vehicle speed
is not in its allowable gear shifting range.
Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift
down while the indicator is blinking.
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
Cruise Control *
Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the
accelerator. Use cruise control on freeways or open roads where you can travel at a
constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.
Desired speed in a range above
roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
Always keep sufficient distance
between you and the vehicle in
front of you.
Use the cruise control only when traveling
on open highways in good weather.
■ Shift positions for cruise control:
It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed
when driving uphill or downhill.
In (D or (S
How to use
button on the
steering wheel.
* Not available on all models
CRUISE MAIN is on in the
instrument panel.
Cruise control is ready to use.
When not using cruise control:
Turn off cruise control by pressing the CRUISE
button.
Driving
■ Press the CRUISE
Models with full
color display
3 WARNING
Improper use of the cruise control can lead
to a crash.
When to use
■ Vehicle speed for cruise control:
1Cruise Control *
Models without
full color display
Continued
279
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
Models with full
color display
Models with full
color display
Models without
full color display
Models without
full color display
On
On
DECEL/SET Button
Driving
On when cruise control begins
Press and release
Take your foot off the pedal and press the DECEL/SET button when you reach the
desired speed.
The moment you release the DECEL/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise
control begins. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on.
280
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control *
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/ACCEL or DECEL/SET buttons
on the steering wheel.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases until you
release it. This speed is then set.
1To Cancel
■ To Cancel
CRUISE
Button
CANCEL
Button
To cancel cruise control, do any of the
following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the CRUISE button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
The CRUISE CONTROL indicator goes off.
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/
ACCEL button while driving at a speed of at least 25
mph (40 km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
• When the CRUISE button is turned off
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control is canceled automatically.
281
uuWhen DrivinguFront Sensor Camera *
Front Sensor Camera *
The camera, used in systems such as LDW, LKAS, ACC, and CMBSTM, is designed to
detect an object that triggers any of the systems to operate its functions.
■ Camera Location and Handling Tips
This camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
Front Sensor Camera
Driving
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera’s sensing
system to shut off, when parking, find a shady
area or face the front of the vehicle away from
the sun. If you use a reflective sun shade, do
not allow it to cover the camera housing.
Covering the camera can concentrate heat on
it.
1Front Sensor Camera *
Never apply a film or attach any objects to
windshield, the hood, or the front grill that could
obstruct the camera’s field of vision and cause the
system to operate abnormally.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the camera’s field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Acura replacement windshield. Making even
minor repairs within the camera’s field of vision or
installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
Do not place an object on the top of the instrument
panel. It may reflect onto the windshield and prevent
the system from detecting lane lines properly.
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Camera Temperature Too High message
appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode
with the air flow directed towards the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
282
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguFront Sensor Camera *
1Front Sensor Camera *
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Clean Front Windshield message
appears:
• Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windshield. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windshield and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Driving
* Not available on all models
283
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and a set following distance behind a
vehicle detected ahead of yours, without you having to keep your foot on the brake
or the accelerator.
When to use
■ Vehicle speed for adaptive cruise control:
Desired speed in a range above roughly
25 mph (40 km/h) ~
The camera is
located behind the
rearview mirror.
■ Shift positions for adaptive cruise control:
The radar sensor is
in the front grille.
Improper use of ACC can lead to a crash.
Use ACC only when travelling on open
highways in good weather.
ACC has limited braking capability.
How to use
Driving
the steering wheel.
3 WARNING
3 WARNING
In (D or (S
■ Press the MAIN button on
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
ACC (green) is on in
the instrument panel.
ACC is ready to use.
When your vehicle speed drops below
22 mph (35 km/h), ACC will
automatically cancel and no longer will
apply your vehicle’s brakes.
Always be prepared to apply the brake
pedal when conditions require.
Important Reminder
As with any system, there are limits to ACC. Use the
brake pedal whenever necessary, and always keep a
safe distance between your vehicle and other vehicles.
The radar sensor for ACC is shared with the collision
mitigation braking systemTM (CMBSTM).
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) * P. 318
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
284
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
DECEL/SET Button
Press and release
On when ACC begins
When not using ACC: Turn off adaptive cruise by
pressing the MAIN button.
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the DECEL/SET button when you reach the
desired speed.
The moment you release the DECEL/SET
Set Vehicle Distance
button, the set speed is fixed, and adaptive
cruise control begins.
u A vehicle icon and distance bars appear
on the multi-information display.
Do not use ACC under these conditions:
• In poor visibility.
• In heavy traffic.
• When you must slow down and speed up
repeatedly.
• On winding roads.
• When you enter a toll gate, interchange, service
area, parking area, etc. In these areas, there is no
vehicle ahead of you, but ACC would still try to
accelerate to your set speed.
• In bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
• On a slippery road (for example a road covered
with ice or snow).
• When going down a steep hill where the engine
braking does not work sufficiently.
Set Vehicle Speed
* Not available on all models
Continued
285
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ When in Operation
1When in Operation
The radar sensor monitors the distance between your vehicle and a vehicle ahead of
you. When the sensor detects a change in distance, the system responds by
accelerating or braking your vehicle in order to maintain the set speed and following
distance as necessary.
■ When ACC detects a
■ When the vehicle goes
vehicle within ACC range:
If the vehicle ahead of you slows down abruptly, or if
another vehicle cuts in front of you, the beeper
sounds and a message appears on the multiinformation display to alert you to brake.
Beep
out of ACC range:
The beeper sounds once and
the vehicle icon appears on the
multi-information display.
The beeper sounds once and
the vehicle icon on the multiinformation display becomes
a dotted-line contour.
Driving
Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate
distance from the vehicle ahead.
Even if the distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle ahead is short, ACC may start accelerating
your vehicle under the following circumstances:
• The vehicle ahead of you is going at almost the
same speed as, or faster than your vehicle.
• A vehicle that cuts in front of you is going faster
than your vehicle, gradually distancing itself from
you.
ACC Range: 394 ft. (120 m)
If you do not want to hear a beep when the system
detects a vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of
ACC range, you can change the pre-running detect
car beep setting.
2 Customized Features P. 106
286
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ There is no vehicle ahead
1When in Operation
Your vehicle cruises at the set speed.
■ A vehicle ahead is within ACC range and going slower than the set speed
Your vehicle slows down, and maintains the same speed as the speed of the vehicle
ahead to maintain the set following distance.
■ A vehicle ahead is within ACC range and going at a steady speed
Your vehicle follows the vehicle ahead of it, keeping a constant distance, without
going beyond the set speed.
■ A vehicle ahead goes out of range
ACC accelerates your vehicle to the set speed, and then maintains it.
■ When you depress the accelerator pedal
Continued
ACC may momentarily apply brakes or sound an alert
if there is a vehicle or building adjacent to your
vehicle and:
• You make a sudden turn or are driving on a narrow
road.
• You abruptly move the steering wheel.
• Your vehicle is unusually positioned within your
lane (e.g., at a slight diagonal to the lane direction).
Driving
You can temporarily increase the vehicle speed. In this case, there is no audible or
visual alerts even if a vehicle is in ACC range.
ACC stays on unless you cancel it. Once you release the accelerator pedal, the
system resumes the set speed.
Limitations
Be aware that ACC has limitations. For example, it is
not designed to operate when a vehicle ahead of
yours is going slower than 12 mph (20 km/h) or is
parked. Smaller vehicles, such as motorcycles, may
also be difficult for the system to detect depending
on their size.
You must always be prepared to use the brake pedal
to maintain a safe distance with other vehicles.
287
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/ACCEL or DECEL/SET buttons
on the steering wheel.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
Driving
288
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph (1 km/h).
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases by about
5 mph (5 km/h).
If a vehicle ahead is going at a speed slower than your
increased set speed, ACC may not accelerate your
vehicle. This is to maintain the set following distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ To Change Vehicle Distance
Distance Button
1To Change Vehicle Distance
Press the (distance) button to change ACC
range.
Each time you press the button, the following
distance (the distance behind a vehicle
detected ahead of you) setting cycles through
short, middle, long, and extra long following
distances.
Determine the most appropriate following
distance setting based on your specific driving
conditions. Be sure to adhere to any following
distance requirements set by local regulation.
The driver must in all circumstances preserve a
sufficient braking distance from the vehicle which
precedes it and be aware that minimum distances of
spacing can be provided by the provisions of the
Motorway Code locally applicable and that it is the
driver’s responsibility to respect those laws.
Driving
Continued
289
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
The higher your vehicle’s following-speed is, the greater the short, middle, long or
extra long following distance becomes. See the following examples for your
reference.
Vehicle
Distance
When the vehicle speed is:
50 mph (80 km/h)
65 mph (104 km/h)
84 feet
26 meters
1.1 sec
102 feet
31 meters
1.1 sec
111 feet
34 meters
1.5 sec
139 feet
43 meters
1.5 sec
155 feet
48 meters
2.1 sec
202 feet
62 meters
2.1 sec
215 feet
66 meters
3.0 sec
285 feet
87 meters
3.0 sec
Short
Driving
Middle
Long
Extra Long
290
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ To Cancel
1To Cancel
To cancel ACC, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
Resuming the prior set speed: After you have
canceled adaptive cruise control, you can resume the
prior set speed while it is still displayed. Press the
RES/ACCEL button when driving at a speed of at
least 25 mph (40 km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h)
• When the MAIN button is turned off
■ Automatic cancellation
1Automatic cancellation
Continued
ACC Off comes on for about three seconds when
ACC has been automatically canceled.
Driving
The beeper sounds and a message appears on the multi-information display when
ACC is automatically canceled. Any of these conditions may cause the ACC
cancellation:
• Your vehicle speed slows down to 22 mph (35 km/h) and below.
• Bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
• When the radar sensor in the front grille gets dirty.
• The vehicle ahead of you cannot be detected.
• An abnormal tire condition is detected, or the tires are skidding.
• Driving on a mountainous road, or driving off road for extended periods.
• Abrupt steering wheel movement.
• When the ABS, VSA® or CMBSTM is activated.
• When the ABS or VSA® indicator comes on.
Even though ACC has been automatically canceled,
you can still resume the prior set speed. Wait until the
condition that caused ACC to cancel improves, then
press the DECEL/SET button.
291
uuWhen DrivinguAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC) *
■ To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
Press and hold the
1To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
(distance) button for one second.
Cruise Mode Selected appears on the multi-information display for two seconds,
and then the mode switches to Cruise.
To switch back to ACC, press and hold the
ACC ON
button again for one second.
Cruise
Control ON
Driving
Distance Button
292
Always be aware which mode you are in. When you
are driving in Cruise mode, the system will not assist
you to maintain a following-distance from a vehicle
ahead of you.
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Alerts you when the system determines a possibility of your vehicle unintentionally
crossing over detected lane markings.
■ How the System Works
If your vehicle is getting too close to detected
left or right side lane markings without a turn
signal activated, LDW will give audible and
visual alerts.
The beeper sounds and the Lane Departure
message appears on the multi-information
display, letting you know that you need to
take appropriate action.
LDW only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. LDW may not detect all
lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will vary
based on weather, speed and lane marker condition.
It is always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
1How the System Activates
The system begins to search for lane markings when all the following conditions are
met:
• The vehicle is traveling between about 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in continuous operation.
* Not available on all models
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LDW has limitations.
Over-reliance on LDW may result in a collision. It is
always your responsibility to keep the vehicle within
your driving lane.
Driving
■ How the System Activates
1Lane Departure Warning (LDW) *
Continued
LDW may automatically shut off and the LDW
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 66
293
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
■ LDW On and Off
Indicator
LDW Button
Driving
294
Press the LDW button to turn the system on
and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on
when the system is on.
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
■ LDW Conditions and Limitations
LDW may not activate or may not recognize lanes, and may activate even when
keeping in the middle of a lane, under certain conditions. Some examples of these
conditions are listed below.
■ Environmental conditions
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the front windshield.
■ Roadway conditions
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
• The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
Continued
295
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning (LDW) *
• When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• When driving on roads with double lines.
■ Vehicle conditions
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too hot.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire *, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
Driving
296
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
Provides steering input to help keep the vehicle in the middle of a detected lane and
provides audible and visual alerts if the vehicle is detected drifting out of its lane.
Beeps and a warning display alert you
that the vehicle is drifting out of a
detected lane.
■ LKAS camera
Monitors the lane
lines
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
Important Safety Reminders
The LKAS is for your convenience only. It is not a
substitute for your vehicle control. The system does
not work if you take your hands off the steering
wheel or fail to steer the vehicle.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 91
Do not place objects on the instrument panel.
Objects may reflect on the front windshield and
prevent correct detection of the traffic lanes.
Driving
LKAS only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. LKAS may not detect all
lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will vary
based on weather, speed, and lane marker condition.
It is always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
The LKAS is convenient when it is used on freeways.
The LKAS may not work properly or may work
improperly under the certain conditions:
2 LKAS Conditions and Limitations P. 303
When you operate the turn signals to change lanes, the system is suspended, and
resumes after the signals are off.
If you make a lane change without operating the turn signals, the LKAS alerts
activate, and torque is applied to the steering.
* Not available on all models
Continued
297
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
■ Lane Keep Support Function
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
Provides assistance to keep the vehicle in the center of the lane. When the vehicle
nears a white or yellow line, steering force of the electric power steering will become
stronger.
The LKAS may not function as designed on while
driving in frequent stop and go traffic, or on roads
with sharp curves.
When it fails to detect lanes, the system will
temporarily be cancelled. When lane is detected,
system will recover automatically.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
If the vehicle drifts toward either left or right lane line
due to the system applying torque, turn off the LKAS
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Driving
■ Lane Departure Warning Function
When the vehicle enters the warning area, LKAS alerts you with beeps as well a
warning display.
Warning area
Warning area
298
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
■ When the System can be Used
The system can be used when the following conditions are met.
• The lane in which you are driving has detectable lane markers on both sides, and
your vehicle is in the center of the lane.
• The vehicle speed is between about 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• You are driving on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in continuous operation.
■ How to activate the system
MAIN Button
Driving
LKAS Button
1. Press the MAIN button.
u The LKAS is on in the multi-information
display.
The system is ready to use.
2. Press the LKAS button.
u Lane outlines appear on the multiinformation display.
The system is activated.
Continued
299
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
3. Keep your vehicle near the center of the
lane while driving.
u The dotted outer lines change to solid
ones once the system starts operating
after detecting the left and right lane
markings.
■ To cancel
The LKAS temporarily deactivates when it fails to
detect lane lines. When the system detects the lines
again, it comes back on automatically.
1To cancel
MAIN Button
To cancel the LKAS:
Press the MAIN or LKAS button.
Driving
The LKAS is turned off every time you stop the
engine, even if you turned it on the last time
you drove the vehicle.
LKAS Button
300
1When the System can be Used
Pressing the MAIN button also turns ACC on and off.
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
■ The system operation is suspended if
When the LKAS is suspended,
the lane lines on the multiinformation display change to
contour lines, and the beeper
sounds.
you:
• Set the wipers to continuous operation.
u Turning the wipers off resumes the
LKAS.
• Decrease the vehicle speed to about 40
mph (64 km/h) or less.
u Increasing the vehicle speed to about 45
mph (72 km/h) or more resumes the
LKAS.
• Depress the brake pedal.
u The LKAS resumes and starts detecting
the lane lines again once you release the
brake pedal.
Driving
Models with automatic intermittent wipers
• Set the wiper switch to AUTO and the
wipers operate continuously.
u The LKAS resumes when the wipers stop
or operate intermittently.
■ The LKAS may automatically be suspended when:
•
•
•
•
The system fails to detect lane lines.
The steering wheel is quickly turned.
You fail to steer the vehicle.
The vehicle runs on a curved road over the speed limit.
Once these conditions no longer exist, the LKAS automatically resumes.
Continued
301
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
■ The LKAS may automatically be canceled when:
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
• When driving through a sharp curve.
• When driving at a speed in excess of approximately 90 mph (145 km/h).
• When the ABS or VSA® systems engage.
A beeper will sound if the LKAS is automatically canceled.
Driving
302
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
■ LKAS Conditions and Limitations
The system may not detect lane markings and therefore may not keep the vehicle in
the middle of a lane under certain conditions, including the following:
■ Environmental conditions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the front windshield.
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
• The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
Continued
Driving
■ Roadway conditions
303
uuWhen DrivinguLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) *
• When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• When driving on roads with double lines.
■ Vehicle conditions
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire *, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
Driving
304
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System
VSA® helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less
than what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces.
It does so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.
■ VSA® Operation
When VSA® activates, you may notice that the
engine does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
The VSA® may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire, and the air pressures as specified.
When the VSA® indicator comes on and stays on
while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
VSA® System
Indicator
The main function of the VSA® system is generally
known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The
system also includes a traction control function.
Continued
Driving
VSA® cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
305
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
■ VSA® On and Off
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To turn the VSA® system on and off, press and
hold it until you hear a beep.
VSA® will stop and the indicator will come on.
VSA® OFF Indicator
To turn it on again, press the
button until you hear a beep.
(VSA® OFF)
VSA® is turned on every time you start the
engine, even if you turned it off the last time
you drove the vehicle.
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
Without VSA®, your vehicle will have normal braking
and cornering ability, but it will not have VSA®
traction and stability enhancement.
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA® temporarily switched off.
When the VSA® system is off, the traction control
system is also off. You should only attempt to free
your vehicle with the VSA® off if you are not able to
free it when the VSA® is on.
Driving
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
switch VSA® on again. We do not recommend driving
your vehicle with the VSA® and traction control
systems switched off.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
306
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information (BSI) System *
Blind spot information (BSI) System *
Is designed to detect vehicles in specified alert zones adjacent to your vehicle,
particularly in harder to see areas commonly known as “blind spots.”
When the system detects vehicles approaching from behind in adjacent lanes, the
appropriate indicator comes on for a few seconds, providing assistance when you
change lanes.
■ How the system works
Radar sensors detect a
vehicle in the alert zone
when your vehicle is
moving forward at
between 20 mph (32 km/h)
and 100 mph (160 km/h).
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on the blind spot
information system when changing lanes.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
Alert Zone
A
B
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, BSI has limitations. Over
reliance on BSI may result in a collision.
The system is for your convenience only. Even if an
object is within the alert zone, the following
situations may occur.
• The BSI alert indicator may not come on due to
obstruction (splashes, etc.) even without the BLIND
SPOT NOT AVAILABLE/Blind Spot Info Not
Available multi-information display appearing.
• The BSI alert indicator may come on even with the
message appearing.
C
Continued
Driving
Alert zone range
A: Approx. 1.6 ft. (0.5 m)
B: Approx. 10 ft. (3 m)
C: Approx. 10 ft. (3 m)
Radar Sensors:
underneath the
rear bumper
corners
1Blind spot information (BSI) System *
307
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information (BSI) System *
■ When the system detects a vehicle
Comes on when:
● A vehicle enters the alert zone from behind
to overtake you with a speed difference of
no more than 31 mph (50 km/h) from your
vehicle.
● You pass a vehicle with a speed difference
of no more than 12 mph (20 km/h).
Blinks and a beeper sounds when:
You move the turn signal lever in the direction
of the detected vehicle. The beeper sounds
three times.
1Blind spot information (BSI) System *
Comes On
Blinks
BSI Alert Indicator
The BSI alert indicator may not come on under the
following conditions:
• A vehicle does not stay in the alert zone for more
than two seconds.
• A vehicle is parked in a side lane.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and the
vehicle you are passing is greater than 6 mph (10
km/h).
• An object not detected by the radar sensors
approaches or passes your vehicle.
• A vehicle running in the adjacent lane is a
motorcycle or other small vehicle.
The system does not operate when in (R .
Driving
You can change the setting for BSI.
2 Customized Features P. 100, 106
308
Turn the system off when towing a trailer.
The system may not work properly for the following
reasons:
• The added mass tilts the vehicle and changes the
radar coverage.
• The trailer itself can be detected by the radar
sensors, causing the BSI alert indicators to come on.
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information (BSI) System *
1Blind spot information (BSI) System *
BSI may be adversely affected when:
• Objects (guard rails, poles, trees, etc.) are detected.
• An object that does not reflect radio waves well,
such as a motorcycle, is in the alert zone.
• Driving on a curved road.
• A vehicle is moving from a far lane to the adjacent
lane.
• The system picks up external electrical interference.
• The rear bumper or the sensors have been improperly
repaired or the rear bumper has been deformed.
• The orientation of the sensors has been changed.
• In bad weather (Heavy rain, snow, and fog).
For a proper BSI use:
labels or stickers of any kind.
• Take your vehicle to a dealer if you need the rear
bumper corner area or the radar sensors to be
repaired, or the rear bumper corner area is strongly
impacted.
* Not available on all models
Driving
• Always keep the rear bumper corner area clean.
• Do not cover the rear bumper corner area with
309
uuWhen DrivinguAll-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent Control System *
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent Control System *
Your vehicle is equipped with the AWD with intelligent control system. When the
system senses a loss of front wheel traction, it automatically transfers some power
to the rear wheels. This allows you to utilize all available traction and may increase
mobility.
You still need to exercise the same care when accelerating, steering, and braking
that you would in a two wheel drive vehicle.
If you excessively spin all four wheels and overheat the AWD with intelligent control
system, only the front wheels receive power. Stop until the system cools down.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Driving
Monitors the tire pressure while you are
driving. If your vehicle’s tire pressure becomes
significantly low, the low tire pressure/TPMS
indicator comes on and a message appears on
the multi-information display.
1All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent Control System *
NOTICE
Do not continuously spin the front tires of your
vehicle. Continuously spinning the front tires can
cause transmission or rear differential damage.
The AWD with intelligent control system may not
function properly if tire type and size are mixed.
Make sure to use the same size and type of tire, and
the air pressures as specified.
2 Tire and Wheel Replacement P. 376
1Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tire pressure and can
trigger the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come
on.
2 If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks P. 419
Tire pressure checked and inflated in:
• Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
• Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will not come
on as a result of over inflation.
The TPMS audibly and visually informs you of
changes in tire pressure of the individual tire that you
are adjusting using audible and visual indications.
2 If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks P. 419
310
* Not available on all models
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
■ Tire Pressure Monitor
Models with
full color display
Models without
full color display
1Tire Pressure Monitor
To select the tire pressure monitor, set the power
mode to ON, and press the
/
(information) button until you see the tire
pressure screen.
The pressure for each tire is displayed in PSI
(U.S.) or kPa (Canada).
Models with
full color display
Models without
full color display
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE/Tire Pressures Low
is displayed when a tire has significantly low
pressure. The specific tire is displayed on the
screen.
The pressure displayed on the multi-information
display can be slightly different from the actual
pressure as measured by a gauge. If there is a
significant difference between the two values, or if
the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator and the message
on the multi-information display do not go off after
you have inflated the tire to the specified pressure,
have the system checked by a dealer.
CHECK TPMS SYSTEM/Tire Pressure Monitor
Problem may appear if you drive with the compact
spare tire *, or there is a problem with the TPMS.
Driving
* Not available on all models
311
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low
tire pressure telltale
Driving
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s
handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
312
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the
level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
Driving
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including
the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or
more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
313
Braking
Brake System
■ Parking Brake
1Parking Brake
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parking.
To apply:
Depress the parking brake pedal down with
your foot.
NOTICE
Release the parking brake fully before driving. The
rear brakes and axle can be damaged if you drive
with the parking brake applied.
If you start driving without fully releasing the parking
brake, a buzzer sounds as a warning, and RELEASE
PARKING BRAKE/Release Parking Brake appears
on the multi-information display.
Always apply the parking brake when parking.
To release:
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Depress the parking brake.
Driving
314
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ Foot Brake
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist
helps reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system increases
the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an emergency
situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering control when
braking very hard.
2 Brake Assist System P. 317
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 316
1Foot Brake
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, the brake pads need to be
replaced. Have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your
foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a
lower gear.
Driving
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
Your vehicle is equipped with a hydraulic brake
booster that, under certain conditions, such as
braking at high altitudes, supplements the vacuum
power assist. When the hydraulic brake booster
activates, you may hear a motor sound and a slight
vibration in the pedal. This is normal.
315
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
■ ABS
Helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by
pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
■ ABS operation
Driving
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Keep holding the
pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very
hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately
if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
When the vehicle speed goes under 6 mph (10 km/h), the ABS stops.
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use an
incorrect tire type and size.
When the ABS indicator comes on while driving,
there may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking is not affected, there is a
possibility of the ABS not operating. Have the vehicle
checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes
to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control
during hard braking.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
stopping distance than a vehicle without the ABS:
• When driving on rough road surfaces, including
when driving on uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
snow.
• When tire chains are installed.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
316
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
■ Brake assist system operation
Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Driving
317
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
Can assist you when there is a possibility of your vehicle colliding with a vehicle or a
pedestrian detected in front of yours. The CMBSTM is designed to alert you when a
potential collision is determined, as well as to reduce your vehicle speed to help
minimize collision severity when a collision is deemed unavoidable.
■ How the system works
When to use
The camera is
located behind the
rearview mirror.
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
Important Safety Reminder
The CMBSTM is designed to reduce the severity of an
unavoidable collision. It does not prevent collision nor
stop the vehicle automatically. It is still your
responsibility to operate the brake pedal and steering
wheel appropriately according to the driving
conditions.
The CMBSTM may not activate or may not detect a
vehicle in front of your vehicle under certain
conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 322
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
Driving
The radar sensor is
in the front grille.
The system starts monitoring the roadway ahead when your vehicle speed is about
3 mph (5 km/h) and there is a vehicle in front of you.
The CMBSTM activates when:
● The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle or pedestrian
detected in front of you becomes about 3 mph (5 km/h) and over with a chance
of a collision.
● Your vehicle speed is about 62 mph (100 km/h) or less and there is a chance of a
collision with an oncoming detected vehicle or a pedestrian in front of you.
318
* Not available on all models
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ When the system activates
1When the system activates
The system provides visual and audible alerts of a possible collision, and stops
if the collision is avoided.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change
lanes, etc.).
Visual Alerts
The camera in the CMBSTM is also designed to detect
pedestrians.
However, this pedestrian detection feature may not
activate or may not detect a pedestrian in front of
your vehicle under certain conditions.
Refer to the ones indicating the pedestrian detection
limitations from the list.
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 322
Beep
At system’s earliest collision alert stage, you can change the distance (Long/
Normal/Short) between vehicles at which alerts will come on through multiinformation display setting options.
Driving
Audible Alert
2 List of customizable options P. 109
Continued
319
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ Collision Alert Stages
The system has three alert stages for a possible collision. However, depending on circumstances, the CMBSTM may not go through all of
the stages before initiating the last stage.
CMBSTM
Distance between vehicles
Stage
one
Normal
Long Short
Vehicle
Ahead
Your Vehicle
Driving
Stage
two
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
The radar sensor detects a
vehicle
Audible & Visual WARNINGS
When in Long, visual and audible alerts
come on at a longer distance from a
There is a risk of a collision with
vehicle ahead than in Normal setting,
the vehicle ahead of you.
and in Short, at a shorter distance than in
Normal.
The risk of a collision has
increased, time to respond is
reduced.
Braking
—
Lightly applied
Visual and audible alerts.
Stage
three
320
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
The CMBSTM determines that a
collision is unavoidable.
Forcefully applied
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ CMBSTM On and Off
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
Press this button until the beeper sounds to
switch the system on or off.
The CMBSTM may automatically shut off, and the
CMBSTM indicator will come and stay on under certain
conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 322
When the CMBSTM is off:
• The CMBSTM indicator in the instrument
panel comes on.
• A message on the multi-information display
reminds you that the system is off.
The CMBSTM is in the previously selected ON or
OFF setting each time you start the engine.
Driving
* Not available on all models
Continued
321
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations
The system may automatically shut off and the CMBSTM indicator will come on under
certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below. Other
conditions may reduce some of the CMBSTM functions.
2 Front Sensor Camera * P. 282
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between objects and the background.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as vehicles and pedestrians.
Reflections on the interior of the front windshield.
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on curvy, winding, or undulating roads.
322
* Not available on all models
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ Vehicle conditions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
The outside of the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
The inside of the windshield is fogged.
An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire *, etc.).
When tire chains are installed.
The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
The camera temperature gets too hot.
Driving with the parking brake applied.
When the radar sensor in the front grille gets dirty.
■ Detection limitations
* Not available on all models
Continued
Driving
• A vehicle or pedestrian suddenly crosses in front of you.
• The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you is
too short.
• A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
• When you accelerate rapidly and approach the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you
at high speed.
• The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, bicycle, mobility scooter or other small
vehicle.
• When there are animals in front of your vehicle.
• When you drive on a curved, winding or undulating road that makes it difficult for
the sensor to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle in front of you is
significantly large.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly comes in front of you.
• Another vehicle suddenly comes in front of you at an intersection, etc.
• Your vehicle abruptly crosses over in front of an oncoming vehicle.
323
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
• When driving through a narrow iron bridge.
• When a pedestrian blends in with the background.
• When a pedestrian is bent over or squatting, or when their hands or raised or they
are running.
• When several pedestrians are walking ahead in a group.
• When the lead vehicle suddenly slows down.
• When the camera cannot correctly identify that a pedestrian is present due to an
unusual shape (holding luggage, body position, size).
Limitations applicable to pedestrian detection only
Driving
324
• When there is a group of people in front of your vehicle walking together side by
side.
• Surrounding conditions or belongings of the pedestrian alter the pedestrian’s
shape, preventing the system from recognizing that the person is a pedestrian.
• When the pedestrian is squatting.
• A strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
• When the pedestrian is shorter than about 3.3 feet (1 meter) or taller than about
6.6 feet (2 meters) in height.
uuBrakinguCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ With Little Chance of a Collision
The CMBSTM may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or
when there is no vehicle ahead. Some examples of this are:
■ When Passing
Your vehicle approaches another vehicle ahead of you and you change lanes to pass.
■ At an intersection
Your vehicle approaches or passes another vehicle that is making a left or right turn.
■ On a curve
When driving through curves, your vehicle comes to a point where an oncoming
vehicle is right in front of you.
You drive under a low or narrow bridge at high speed.
For the CMBSTM to work properly:
Always keep the radar sensor cover clean.
Never use chemical solvents or polishing powder for
cleaning the sensor cover. Clean it with water or a
mild detergent.
Do not paint, or apply any coverings or paint to radar
sensor area. This can impact CMBSTM operation.
If you need the radar sensor to be repaired, or
removed, or the radar sensor cover is strongly
impacted, turn off the system by pressing the
CMBSTM off button and take your vehicle to a dealer.
Driving
■ Through a low bridge at high speed
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM) *
■ Speed bumps, road work sites, train tracks, roadside objects, etc.
You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train
tracks or roadside objects [such as a traffic sign and guard rail] on a curve or, when
parking, stationary vehicles and walls.
* Not available on all models
325
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly with the shift lever in (D .
2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
3. Move the shift lever from (D to (P .
4. Turn off the engine.
1Parking Your Vehicle
Always set the parking brake firmly, in particular if you are parked on an incline.
1When Stopped
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
NOTICE
The following can damage the transmission:
• Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
• Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
• Moving the shift lever into (P before the vehicle
stops completely.
Raise the wiper arms when snow is expected.
Driving
326
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
Parking Sensor System *
The corner and center sensors monitor obstacles near your vehicle. The beeper and
audio/information screen let you know the approximate distance between your
vehicle and the obstacle.
■ The sensor location and range
Front Corner Sensors
Rear Corner Sensors
Rear Center Sensors
Front Center Sensors
1Parking Sensor System *
Even when the system is on, always confirm if there is
no obstacle near your vehicle before parking.
The system may not work properly when:
• The sensors are covered with snow, ice, mud or
dirt, etc.
• The vehicle is on uneven surface, such as grass,
bumpy road, or a hill.
• The vehicle has been out in hot or cold weather.
• The system is affected by some electronic devices
that generate ultrasonic waves.
• Driving in bad weather.
The system may not sense:
or sponge.
Within about 24 in (60 cm) or less
* Not available on all models
Front: Within about 32 in (80 cm) or less
Rear: Within about 43 in (110 cm) or less
Continued
• Objects directly under the bumper.
Driving
• Thin or low objects.
• Sonic-absorptive materials, such as snow, cotton,
Do not put any accessories on or around the sensors.
327
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Parking sensor system on and off
With the power mode in ON, press the
parking sensor system button to turn on or off
the system. The indicator in the button comes
on when the system is on.
The front center and front corner sensors start
to detect an obstacle when the shift lever is in
any position other than (P or (R , and the
vehicle speed is less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
The front corner, rear center and rear corner
sensors start to detect an obstacle when the
shift lever is in (R , and the vehicle speed is less
than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Driving
328
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles behind becomes shorter
Length of the
intermittent beep
Distance between the Bumper and Obstacle
Indicator
Corner Sensors
Center Sensors
Moderate
—
Front: About 32-24 in
(80-60 cm)
Rear: About 43-24 in
(110-60 cm)
Short
About 24-18 in
(60-45 cm)
About 24-18 in
(60-45 cm)
Very short
About 18-14 in
(45-35 cm)
About 18-14 in
(45-35 cm)
Continuous
About 14 in
(35 cm) or less
About 14 in
(35 cm) or less
Audio/information screen
Blinks in Yellow*1
Blinks in Amber
Indicators light where the
sensor detects an obstacle
Driving
Blinks in Red
*1: At this stage, only the center sensors detect obstacles.
Continued
329
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Turning off All Rear Sensors
1. Make sure that the parking sensor system is not activated. Set the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
2. Press and hold the parking sensor system button, and set the power mode to ON.
3. Keep pressing the button for 10 seconds. Release the button when the indicator
in the button flashes.
4. Press the button again. The indicator in the button goes off.
u The beeper sounds twice. The rear sensors are now turned off.
To turn the rear sensors on again, follow the above procedure. The beeper sounds
three times when the rear sensors come back on.
Driving
330
1Turning off All Rear Sensors
When you shift to (R , the indicator in the parking
sensor system button blinks as a reminder that the
rear sensors have been turned off.
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
Cross Traffic Monitor *
Monitors the rear corner areas using the radar sensors when reversing, and alerts
you if a vehicle approaching from a rear corner is detected.
The system is convenient when you are backing out of a parking space.
1Cross Traffic Monitor *
3 CAUTION
Cross Traffic Monitor cannot detect all
approaching vehicles and may not detect
an approaching vehicle at all.
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
back up the vehicle before doing so may
result in a collision.
Do not solely rely on the system when
reversing; always also use your mirrors, and
look behind and to the sides of your vehicle
before reversing.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Driving
Models with Parking Sensor System
The parking sensor system’s alerting buzzer overrides
the Cross Traffic Monitor buzzer when the sensors
are detecting obstacles at the closest range.
331
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
■ How the System Works
1Cross Traffic Monitor *
The system activates when:
• The power mode is in ON.
• The transmission is in (R .
• The Cross Traffic Monitor system is turned
on.
2 Cross Traffic Monitor On and Off P. 333
2 See Navigation System Manual
Radar sensors:
Underneath the rear bumper
corners
Driving
When a vehicle is detected approaching from a rear corner, Cross Traffic Monitor
alerts you with a buzzer and a displayed warning.
The system will not detect a vehicle that approaches from directly behind your
vehicle, nor will it provide alerts about a detected vehicle when it moves directly
behind your vehicle.
The system does not provide alerts for a vehicle that is moving away from your
vehicle, and it may alert for pedestrians, bicycles, or stationary objects.
332
* Not available on all models
Cross traffic monitor may not detect or may delay
detecting an approaching vehicle, or may alert
detection without an approaching vehicle under the
following conditions:
• An obstacle, such as another vehicle and a wall,
near your vehicle’s rear bumper, is blocking the
radar sensor’s scope.
• Your vehicle is moving at the speed of about 3 mph
(5 km/h) or higher.
• A vehicle is approaching at the speed other than
between about 6 and 16 mph (10 and 25 km/h).
• The system picks up external interference such as
other radar sensors from another vehicle or strong
radio wave transmitted from a facility nearby.
• Either corner of the rear bumper is covered with
snow, ice, mud or dirt.
• When there is bad weather.
• Your vehicle is on an incline.
• Your vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load in the rear.
• Your vehicle is reversing towards a wall, a poll, a
vehicle, etc.
• The rear bumper or the sensors have been
improperly repaired or the rear bumper has been
deformed. Have a vehicle checked by a dealer.
For proper operation, always keep the rear bumper
corner area clean.
Do not cover the rear bumper corner area with labels
or stickers of any kind.
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
■ When the System Detects a Vehicle
1When the System Detects a Vehicle
If the
on the lower right changes to
in amber
when the shift lever is in (R , obstructions (mud,
snow, ice, etc.) may have accumulated in the vicinity
of the sensor. The system is temporarily canceled.
Check the bumper corners for any obstructions, and
thoroughly clean the area if necessary.
Arrow Icon
Wide View
Normal View
Top Down View
If the
comes on in amber when the shift lever is in
(R , there may be a problem with the Cross Traffic
Monitor system. Do not use the system and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
An arrow icon appears on the side a vehicle is approaching on the audio/information
screen.
You can switch on and off the system using
the audio/information screen.
Driving
■ Cross Traffic Monitor On and Off
2 See Navigation System Manual
Icon
333
Multi-View Rear Camera
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
Models with navigation system
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
For models with navigation system, see Navigation System Manual.
Models without navigation system
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view. The display
automatically changes to the rear view when the shift lever is moved to (R .
■ Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Wide View Mode
Guidelines
Bumper
Normal View Mode
Driving
Camera
Approx. 20 inches (50 cm)
Tailgate Open Range
Approx. 39 inches (1 m)
Approx. 79 inches (2 m)
Top Down View Mode
Approx. 118 inches (3 m)
You can view three different camera angles on the rearview display. Press the
selector knob to switch the angle.
If the last used viewing mode is Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the next
time you shift into (R . If Top view was last used, Wide mode is selected.
334
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing
up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and
high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do
not rely on the rearview display which does not give
you all information about conditions at the back of
your vehicle.
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
Refueling
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
Unleaded premium gasoline, pump octane number 91 or higher
Use of lower octane gasoline can cause occasional metallic knocking noise in the
engine and will result in decreased engine performance.
Use of gasoline with a pump octane less than 87 can lead to engine damage.
■ Top tier detergent gasoline
Because the level of detergency and additives in gasoline vary in the market, Acura
endorses the use of “TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” where available to help
maintain the performance and reliability of your vehicle. TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline meets a new gasoline standard jointly established by leading automotive
manufacturers to meet the needs of today’s advanced engines.
NOTICE
We recommend quality gasoline containing
detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and
engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain
good performance, fuel economy, and emissions
control, we strongly recommend the use of gasoline
that does NOT contain harmful manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT, if such gasoline is
available.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely
affect performance, and cause the malfunction
indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on.
If this happens, contact a dealer for service. Some
gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such as
ethanol. Your vehicle is designed to operate on
oxygenated gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol
by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol.
If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try
another service station or switch to another brand of
gasoline.
Driving
Qualifying gasoline retailers will, in most cases, identify their gasoline as having met
“TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” standards at the retail location. This fuel is
guaranteed to contain the proper level of detergent additives and be free of metallic
additives. The proper level of detergent additives, and absence of harmful metallic
additives in gasoline, help avoid build-up of deposits in your engine and emission
control system.
1Fuel Information
For further important fuel-related information for your vehicle, or on information on
gasoline that does not contain MMT, visit Acura Owners at owners.acura.com In
Canada, visit www.acura.ca for additional information on gasoline. For more
information on top tier gasoline, visit www.toptiergas.com.
■ Fuel tank capacity: 16 US gal (60.5 liters)
335
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
How to Refuel
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the lower left corner of the
dashboard.
u The fuel fill door opens.
Pull
4. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a
release of air, wait until this stops, then turn
the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.
1How to Refuel
3 WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Driving
Cap
Cap
Holder
336
5. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.
6. Insert the filler nozzle fully.
u When the tank is full, the filler nozzle will
click off automatically. This leaves space
in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands
with a change in the temperature.
7. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap,
tightening it until you hear it click at least
once.
u Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
If the fuel filler nozzle keeps turning off when the
tank is not full, there may be a problem with the
pump’s fuel vapor recovery system. Try filling at
another pump. If this does not fix the problem,
consult a dealer.
Do not continue to add fuel after the nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy
Fuel economy depends on several conditions, including driving conditions, your
driving habits, the condition of your vehicle, and loading. Depending on these and
other conditions, you may or may not achieve the rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
■ Maintenance and Fuel Economy
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle in accordance with the messages displayed on the
multi-information display.
• Use the recommended viscosity engine oil, displaying the API Certification Seal.
• Maintain the specified tire pressure.
• Do not load the vehicle with excess cargo.
• Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle’s underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
1Improving Fuel Economy
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
Miles driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
100
Liter
Kilometers
L per 100 km
In Canada, posted fuel economy numbers are
established following a simulated test. For more
information on how this test is performed, please visit
http://oee.nrcan.gc.ca/
Driving
337
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
• Do not install accessories on the windshield. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
• Do not install any accessories over areas marked SRS Airbag, on the sides or backs
of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows.
Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the
vehicle’s airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags
deploy.
• Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 420
• Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
Driving
Modifications
Do not modify your vehicle or use non-Acura components that can affect its
handling, stability, and reliability.
Overall vehicle performance can be affected. Always make sure all equipment is
properly installed and maintained, and that it meets federal, state, province,
territory, and local regulations.
338
1Accessories and Modifications
3 WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
Acura Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............ 340
Safety When Performing Maintenance..... 341
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 342
Maintenance MinderTM ..................... 343
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood..... 347
Opening the Hood ........................... 348
Recommended Engine Oil ................ 349
Oil Check ......................................... 350
Adding Engine Oil ............................ 351
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter ..... 352
Engine Coolant ................................ 354
Transmission Fluid............................ 356
Brake Fluid....................................... 357
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 358
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 359
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades.... 366
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires ................................. 370
Tire and Loading Information Label ...... 371
Tire Labeling .................................... 371
Tire and Wheel Replacement ........... 376
Tire Rotation.................................... 377
Winter Tires ..................................... 378
Battery............................................... 379
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery ........... 380
Climate Control System Maintenance .....382
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 383
Exterior Care.................................... 385
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles).......373
Wear Indicators................................ 375
Tire Service Life ................................ 375
339
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
(Note, however, that service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in
effect.) Refer to the separate maintenance booklet for detailed maintenance and
inspection information.
■ Types of Inspection and Maintenance
■ Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
■ Periodic inspections
• Check the automatic transmission fluid level monthly.
2 Automatic Transmission Fluid P. 356
• Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Checking the Brake Fluid P. 357
Maintenance
• Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
U.S. models
Maintenance, replacement, or repair of
emissions control devices and systems may be
done by any automotive repair establishment or
individuals using parts that are “certified” to
EPA standards.
According to state and federal regulations, failure to
perform maintenance on the maintenance main
items marked with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all maintenance services should
be performed in accordance with the intervals
indicated by the multi-information display.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 345
If you want to perform complex maintenance tasks
that require more skills and tools, you can purchase a
subscription to the Service Express website at
www.techinfo.honda.com.
2 Authorized Manuals P. 435
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 370
• Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 359
• Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 366
340
1Inspection and Maintenance
If you want to perform maintenance yourself, make
sure that you have the necessary tools and skills first.
After performing maintenance, update the records in
the separate maintenance booklet.
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here.
However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in
performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform
a given task.
■ Maintenance Safety
• To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
• Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the hood.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them causing a fire.
• To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not
gasoline.
• Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or
compressed air.
• Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.
• The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the engine is off.
• Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before
touching vehicle parts.
• Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away
from moving parts.
3 WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations according
to the schedules in this owner’s manual.
3 WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner’s manual.
Maintenance
■ Vehicle Safety
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
341
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Acura genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Acura genuine parts are manufactured according to the same
high quality standards used in Acura vehicles.
Maintenance
342
Maintenance MinderTM
If the engine oil life is less than 15%, you will see the Maintenance Minder messages
appear on the multi-information display every time you set the power mode to ON.
The messages notify you when to change the engine oil, or when to bring your
vehicle to a dealer for indicated maintenance services.
To Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1Displaying the Engine Oil Life
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press the
/
button repeatedly until the engine oil life appears on the
multi-information display.
Models with full
color display
Models without
full color display
Remaining Engine Oil Life
Button
Continued
Displayed Engine Oil
Life (%)
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
15
10
5
0
Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
100 to 91
90 to 81
80 to 71
70 to 61
60 to 51
50 to 41
40 to 31
30 to 21
20 to 16
15 to 11
10 to 6
5 to 1
0
Maintenance
/
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
There is a list of maintenance main and sub items you
can view on the multi-information display.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 345
343
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Minder Messages on the Multi-Information
Display
Maintenance
Maintenance Message*1
Oil Life Display*1
Explanation
Information
Maintenance Due Soon/
SERVICE DUE SOON
15%
The remaining engine oil life is 15 to 6
percent. Once you switch the display
by pressing the
/
(information)
button, this message will go off.
The engine oil is approaching the end
of its service life, and the maintenance
items should be inspected and serviced
soon.
Maintenance Due Now/
SERVICE DUE NOW
5%
The remaining engine oil life is 5 to 1 The engine oil has almost reached the
percent. Press the
/
button to end of its service life, and the
maintenance items should be
switch to another display.
inspected and serviced as soon as
possible.
Maintenance Past Due/
SERVICE PAST DUE
Negative Distance
A
The remaining engine oil life has
The engine oil life has passed.
passed its service life, and a negative The maintenance items must be
distance appears after driving over 10 inspected and serviced immediately.
miles (U.S. models) or 10 km
(Canadian models). Press the
/
button to switch to another display.
*1 : On the left: Models with full color display
On the right: Models without full color display
The system message indicator (
344
) comes on along with the Maintenance Minder message.
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Service Items
1Maintenance Service Items
• Independent of the Maintenance Minder
information, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
Maintenance Minder Message
Models with full
color display
CODE
Models without
full color display
they are noisy.
Sub
Items
Main
Item
System
Message
Indicator
• Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).
• Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
Sub Items
Main Item
Maintenance Main Items
CODE
Maintenance Sub Items
●
Replace engine oil*1
1
●
Rotate tires
B
●
Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes
Check parking brake adjustment
Check expiration date for Temporary Tire Repair Kit bottle (If
equipped)
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Inspect suspension components
Inspect driveshaft boots
Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA)
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
Inspect exhaust system#
Inspect fuel lines and connections#
2
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
*1: If message, SERVICE DUE NOW does not appear more than 12 months after the display is reset,
change the engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty.
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace the air cleaner element every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
* Not available on all models
●
Replace air cleaner element*2
Replace dust and pollen filter*3
Inspect drive belt
3
●
Replace transmission and transfer * fluid*4
4
●
●
Replace spark plugs
Replace timing belt and inspect water pump*5
Inspect valve clearance
5
●
Replace engine coolant
6
●
Replace rear differential fluid *
●
●
Maintenance
A
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace the dust and pollen filter every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*4: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds or trailer towing results in higher transmission
and transfer temperatures. This requires transmission and transfer fluid changes more frequently than
recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have
the transmission fluid changed at 60,000 miles (100,000 km), then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
*5: If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over 110 °F, 43 °C), in very low temperatures (under 20 °F, -29 °C), replace every 60,000 miles/100,000 km.
Continued
345
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
Reset the engine oil life display if you have performed the maintenance service.
Models with full
color display
Models without
full color display
Maintenance Item Codes Maintenance Item Codes
NOTICE
Failure to reset the engine oil life after a maintenance
service results in the system showing incorrect
maintenance intervals, which can lead to serious
mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the engine oil life display after
completing the required maintenance service. If
someone other than a dealer performs maintenance
service, reset the engine oil life display yourself.
Engine Oil Life
/
Engine Oil Life
Button
SEL/RESET
Button
Maintenance
346
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Select VEHICLE SETTINGS/Vehicle Settings using the
/
button, then
press the SEL/RESET button.
3. Select MAINTENANCE INFO./Maintenance Info. using the
/
button,
then press the SEL/RESET button.
4. Select RESET using the
/
button, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u The service code will disappear and the engine oil life display will return to
100%.
To cancel the oil life reset mode, select CANCEL, then press the SEL/RESET button.
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange Loop)
Engine Coolant
Reserve Tank
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Battery
Maintenance
Automatic
Transmission Fluid
Dipstick (Yellow Loop)
Radiator Cap
347
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOpening the Hood
Opening the Hood
Hood Release Handle
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the hood release handle under the
lower left corner of the dashboard.
u The hood will pop up slightly.
Pull
1Opening the Hood
NOTICE
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are
raised.
The hood will strike the wipers, and may damage
either the hood or the wipers.
When closing the hood, check that the hood is
securely latched.
3. Slide the hood latch lever in the center of
the hood to release the lock mechanism,
and open the hood.
Lever
Maintenance
348
4. Lift the hood up most of the way.
u The hydraulic supports will lift it up the
rest of the way and hold it up.
When closing, lower it to approximately
12 inches (30 cm), then press down firmly with
your hands.
If the hood latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the hood without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRecommended Engine Oil
Recommended Engine Oil
• Genuine Acura Motor Oil
• Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil with an API Certification Seal on the
container.
Oil is a major contributor to your engine’s
performance and longevity. If you drive the
vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil,
the engine may fail or be damaged.
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
This seal indicates the oil is energy conserving
and that it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.
Use a Genuine Acura Motor Oil or another
commercial engine oil of suitable viscosity for
the ambient temperature as shown.
Maintenance
Ambient Temperature
■ Synthetic oil
You may also use synthetic motor oil if it is labeled with the API Certification Seal
and is the specified viscosity grade.
349
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOil Check
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the
oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
Maintenance
350
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil being careful not to overfill.
uuMaintenance Under the HooduAdding Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
Engine Oil
Fill Cap
1Adding Engine Oil
If any oil spills, wipe it up immediately. Spilled oil may
damage the engine compartment components.
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark.
Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and
engine damage.
Maintenance
351
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You must change the engine oil and oil filter regularly in order to maintain the
engine’s lubrication. The engine may be damaged if they are not changed regularly.
Change the oil and filter in accordance with the maintenance message on the multiinformation display.
1. Run the engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature, and then turn the
Drain Bolt
engine off.
2. Open the hood and remove the engine oil
fill cap.
3. Remove the drain bolt and washer from
the bottom of the engine, and drain the
Washer
oil into a suitable container.
Maintenance
352
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
NOTICE
You may damage the environment if you do not
dispose of the oil in a suitable way. If you are
changing the oil by yourself, appropriately dispose of
the used oil. Put the oil in a sealed container and take
it to a recycling center. Do not throw the oil away
into a garbage can or onto the ground.
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Oil Filter
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You will need a special wrench to replace the oil
filter. You can buy this wrench from a dealer.
When installing the new oil filter, follow the
instructions supplied with the oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The
low oil pressure indicator should go off within five
seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check
your work.
Maintenance
4. Remove the oil filter and dispose of the
remaining oil.
5. Check that the filter gasket is not stuck to
the engine contact surface.
u If it is stuck, you must detach it.
6. Wipe away dirt and dust adhering to the
contact surface of the engine block, and
install a new oil filter.
u Apply a light coat of new engine oil to
the oil filter rubber seal.
7. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then
reinstall the drain bolt.
u Tightening torque:
29 lbf∙ft (39 N∙m, 4.0 kgf∙m)
8. Pour the recommended engine oil into the
engine.
u Engine oil change capacity (including
filter):
4.5 US qt (4.3 L)
9. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap securely
and start the engine.
10. Run the engine for a few minutes, and
then check that there is no leak from the
drain bolt or oil filter.
11. Stop the engine, wait for three minutes,
and then check the oil level on the
dipstick.
u If necessary, add more engine oil.
353
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Acura Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the
radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
■ Reserve Tank
1. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
Reserve
Tank
MAX
1Engine Coolant
NOTICE
If temperatures consistently below -22°F (-30°C) are
expected, the coolant mixture should be changed to
a higher concentration. Consult a dealer for more
information.
If Acura antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Acura coolant can result in
corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction
or fail. Have the cooling system flushed and refilled
with Acura antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s cooling system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
Maintenance
354
MIN
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
1Radiator
Radiator Cap
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap counterclockwise and
relieve any pressure in the coolant system.
Do not push the cap down when turning.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
counterclockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank until it
reaches the MAX mark. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
Maintenance
355
uuMaintenance Under the HooduTransmission Fluid
Transmission Fluid
■ Automatic Transmission Fluid
Specified fluid: Acura Automatic Transmission Fluid ATF DW-1
Maintenance
356
Check the fluid level when the engine is at normal operating temperature.
1. Park on level ground, and start the engine.
2. Wait until the radiator fan starts and then
turn off the engine.
u Perform step 3 after waiting for about 60
seconds (less than 90 seconds).
3. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop) from the
Upper Mark
transmission and wipe it with a clean cloth.
HOT
Range
Lower Mark
4. Insert the dipstick all the way back into the
transmission securely, as shown in the
image.
5. Remove the dipstick and check the fluid
level.
u It should be between the upper and
lower marks in the HOT range.
6. If the level is below the lower mark, add
fluid into the dipstick hole to bring it to the
level between the upper and lower marks,
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
1Automatic Transmission Fluid
NOTICE
Do not mix Acura Automatic Transmission Fluid
ATF DW-1 with other transmission fluids.
Using a transmission fluid other than Acura ATF DW1 may adversely affect the operation and durability of
your vehicle’s transmission, and damage the
transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to Acura ATF DW-1 is not covered
by Acura’s new vehicle warranty.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
uuMaintenance Under the HooduBrake Fluid
Brake Fluid
Specified fluid: Acura Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
NOTICE
■ Checking the Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir.
MAX
MIN
Brake Reservoir
1Brake Fluid
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle’s braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
If the specified brake fluid is not available, you should
use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid from a sealed
container as a temporary replacement.
Using any non-Acura brake fluid can cause corrosion
and decrease the longevity of the system. Have the
brake system flushed and refilled with Acura Heavy
Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect for leaks or worn brake pads as
soon as possible.
Maintenance
357
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRefilling Window Washer Fluid
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Check the amount of window washer fluid using the 1/2 mark on the reservoir.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
1/2 Mark
Models with washer level sensor
If the washer fluid is low, a message appears on the multi-information display.
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.
Maintenance
358
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the windshield washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle’s paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the windshield
washer pump.
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
Headlight bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized Acura dealer inspect and replace
the light assembly
1Headlight Bulbs
NOTICE
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area or tow a trailer, have
the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified
technician.
Fog Light Bulbs *
1Fog Light Bulbs *
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
NOTICE
Fog Light: 55 W (H11)
Clip
Screw
Continued
The fog lights are halogen bulbs.
When replacing a bulb, handle it by its plastic case,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
1. Turn the steering wheel all the way to the
opposite side from the fog light being
replaced.
Passenger side: Turn the steering wheel to
the left.
Driver side: Turn the steering wheel to the
right.
2. Remove the holding clip and screw, and
pull the inner fender back.
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration,
or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to
overheat and shatter.
359
uuReplacing Light BulbsuSide Turn Signal Light/Emergency Indicator Light Bulbs
3. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
4. Rotate the old bulb to the left to remove.
5. Insert new bulb.
1Fog Light Bulbs *
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the
central pin to remove the clip.
Central pin
Coupler
Bulb
Tab
Insert the clip with the central pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
Maintenance
Push until the
pin is flat.
Side Turn Signal Light/Emergency Indicator Light
Bulbs
Door mirror side turn light bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized Acura dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
360
* Not available on all models
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal Light/Parking Light/Daytime Running Light and Front Side Marker Light Bulbs
Front Turn Signal Light/Parking Light/Daytime
Running Light and Front Side Marker Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Turn Signal Light/Parking Light/Daytime Running Light: LED type
Front Side Marker Light: 3CP
Bulb
Socket
1. Turn the steering wheel all the way to the
opposite side from the light being replaced.
Passenger side:Turn the steering wheel to
the left.
Driver side:Turn the steering wheel to the
right.
2. Remove the holding clips and screw, and
pull the inner fender back.
1Front Turn Signal Light/Parking Light/Daytime Running Light and
Front Side Marker Light Bulbs
Front turn signal light/parking light/daytime running
light bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized Acura
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
2 Fog Light Bulbs * P. 359
3. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
4. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
361
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light and Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Brake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light and
Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Brake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light: LED type
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge
using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
Bolts
Maintenance
362
2. Use a Phillip-head screwdriver to remove
the bolts.
3. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.
1Brake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light and Rear Turn Signal
Light Bulbs
Brake light/taillight/rear side marker light bulbs are
LED type. Have an authorized Acura dealer inspect
and replace the light assembly.
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light and Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
4. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
Remove the old bulb.
5. Insert a new bulb.
Bulb
Socket
Guide
6. Reinstall the light assembly by sliding it on
to the guide on the body.
Maintenance
363
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBack-Up Light and Taillight Bulbs
Back-Up Light and Taillight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Taillight bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized
Acura dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Back-Up Light: 16W
Taillight: LED type
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge
using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
Remove the old bulb.
3. Insert a new bulb.
Bulb
Maintenance
364
1Back-Up Light and Taillight Bulbs
Socket
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear License Plate Light Bulb
Rear License Plate Light Bulb
When replacing, use the following bulb.
Rear License Plate Light: 5W
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge
using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
Tab
2. Push the tabs to remove the coupler.
3. Remove the old bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
Tab
High-Mount Brake Light Bulb
Maintenance
Bulb
High-mount brake light bulbs are LED type. Have an authorized Acura dealer inspect
and replace the light assembly.
365
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces
of the blade may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
1Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
windshield.
Lock Tab
Maintenance
366
2. Place a cloth on the edge of the lock tab.
Push the lock tab up with a flat-tip screw
driver.
3. Slide the blade from the wiper arm.
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
4. Slide the wiper blade out from its holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
Blade
Top
Retainer
Blade
Tab
6. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the holder should fit in the
indent of the wiper blade.
7. Slide the wiper blade onto the wiper arm,
then push down the lock tab.
8. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
Maintenance
Indent
5. Remove the retainers from the rubber blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new rubber blade.
u Correctly align the rubber protrusion and
the retainer grooves.
367
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Raise the wiper arm off.
1Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
windshield.
2. Slide the wiper blade out from the end with
the indent.
Blade
Maintenance
3. Remove the retainers from wiper blade and
mount to a new rubber blade.
Retainer
Rubber
368
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
4. Slide the wiper blade onto the holder.
u Make sure it is engaged correctly, then
install the wiper blade assembly onto the
wiper arm.
Maintenance
369
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
■ Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tires provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and comfort.
Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label or specification’s page for the specified pressure.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tires make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tires. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tire gauge.
Maintenance
At least once a month and before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tires, including the spare. Even tires in good condition can lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to
20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm2) per month.
■ Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tires and valve stems.
Look for:
• Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tire if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
• Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
• Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
• Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 375
• Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
370
1Checking Tires
3 WARNING
Using tires that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tire inflation and
maintenance.
Measure the air pressure when tires are cold. This
means the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If
necessary, add or release air until the specified
pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tire pressure can be as much as
4–6 psi (30–40 kPa, 0.3–0.4 kgf/cm2) higher than if
checked when cold.
Have a dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tires and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Loading Information Label
Tire and Loading Information Label
The label attached to the driver’s doorjamb provides necessary tire and loading
information.
Label
Example
1Tire and Loading Information Label
The tire and loading information label attached to the
driver’s doorjamb contains:
a The number of people your vehicle can carry.
b The total weight your vehicle can carry. Do not
exceed this weight.
c The original tire sizes for front, rear, and spare.
d The proper cold tire pressure for front, rear, and
spare.
Tire Labeling
Example
Tire Size
Tire
Identification
Number (TIN)
The tires that came on your vehicle have a
number of markings. Those you should be
aware of are described below.
Maximum
Tire Pressure
Tire Size
■ Tire Sizes
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size.
Continued
Following is an example of tire size with an
explanation of what each component means.
P235/60R18 102V
P: Vehicle type (P indicates passenger vehicle).
235: Tire width in millimeters.
60: Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a
percentage of its width).
R: Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
18: Rim diameter in inches.
102: Load index (a numerical code associated with
the maximum load the tire can carry).
V: Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the
maximum speed rating).
Maintenance
Maximum
Tire Load
1Tire Sizes
371
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Labeling
■ Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like
the example in the side column. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire.
■ Glossary of Tire Terminology
Maintenance
372
Cold Tire Pressure – The tire air pressure when the vehicle has been parked for at
least three hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating – Means the maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given
inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure – The maximum tire air pressure that the tire can
hold.
Maximum Load Rating – Means the load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that tire.
Recommended Inflation Pressure – The cold tire inflation pressure recommended
by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI) – Means the projections within the principal grooves
designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread.
1Tire Identification Number (TIN)
DOT B97R FW6X 2209
DOT: This indicates that the tire meets all
requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
B97R: Manufacturer’s identification mark.
FW6X: Tire type code.
22 09: Date of manufacture.
Year
Week
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety
Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction,
and temperature performance according to Department of
Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these
gradings.
■ Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
Continued
For example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.
Maintenance
■ Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear
rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in
driving habits, service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
1Uniform Tire Quality Grading
373
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Maintenance
374
■ Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
1Traction
■ Temperature
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
1Temperature
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWear Indicators
Wear Indicators
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) shallower than
elsewhere on the tire. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tire.
Worn out tires have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tire Service Life
The life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use).
Maintenance
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five
years old. All tires, including the spare, should be removed from service after 10
years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
375
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Wheel Replacement
Tire and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tires with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire’s sidewall). Using tires of a
different size or construction can cause the ABS, vehicle stability assist (VSA®), hill
start assist, and the All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with intelligent control system * to work
incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tires in pairs.
If you replace a wheel, only use TPMS specified wheels approved for your vehicle.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
Maintenance
376
* Not available on all models
1Tire and Wheel Replacement
3 WARNING
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can
affect handling and stability. This can cause
a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Always use the size and type of tires
recommended in this owner’s manual.
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Rotation
Tire Rotation
Rotating tires according to the maintenance messages on the multi-information
display helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tire life.
■ Tires without rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Front
1Tire Rotation
Tires with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tires should be mounted with the rotation
indication mark facing forward, as shown below.
FRONT
Rotation Mark
■ Tires with rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Maintenance
Front
377
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWinter Tires
Winter Tires
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount all season marked “M+S” tires, snow
tires, or tire chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles
when driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent
skidding.
1Winter Tires
3 WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Use tire chains, snow tires, or all season tires when necessary or according to the law.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tires:
• Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tires.
• Mount the tires to all four wheels.
For tire chains:
• Install them on the front tires only.
• Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
Maintenance
378
Cable-type: SCC Radial Chain TC2212MM
• Follow the chain manufacturer’s instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
• Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
• Drive slowly.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding the selection and use of
tire chains.
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle’s brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
When tire chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware that these tires are not designed for winter
driving conditions. For more information, contact a
dealer.
Battery
Checking the Battery
Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead:
• The audio system is disabled.
2 Reactivating the audio system P. 188
1Battery
3 WARNING
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
• The clock resets.
2 Setting the Clock P. 118
• The navigation system * is disabled.
2 Refer to navigation system manual
Charging the Battery
Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle’s electrical system.
Always disconnect the negative (–) cable first, and reconnect it last.
A spark or flame can cause the battery to
explode with enough force to kill or
seriously hurt you.
When conducting any battery
maintenance, wear protective clothing and
a face shield, or have a skilled technician do
it.
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Rinse the terminals with water. Cloth/towel dry the
battery. Coat the terminals with grease to help
prevent future corrosion.
Maintenance
WARNING: Battery post, terminals,
and related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.
When replacing the battery, the replacement must be
of the same specifications.
Please consult a dealer for more information.
* Not available on all models
379
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
Models without two-way keyless access remote
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
1Replacing the Button Battery
NOTICE
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
Battery
Maintenance
380
2. Remove the upper half by carefully prying
on the edge with a coin.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the transmitter.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
uuRemote Transmitter CareuReplacing the Button Battery
Models with two-way keyless access remote
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
u As a convenience, lightly place masking
tape over the remote buttons to hold
them in place.
Battery
Models with two-way keyless access remote
NOTICE
The Remote transmitter is equipped with two
batteries: A standard replaceable CR2032 coin
button battery and an integral non-replaceable
rechargeable battery. To prevent permanent damage
to the rechargeable battery, replace the CR2032
battery every three to four years.
Maintenance
2. Remove the upper half by carefully prying
on the edge with a coin.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the transmitter.
3. Press down on the center of the assembly
and remove the battery.
u When removing the button battery, be
careful not to touch parts around it.
4. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
1Replacing the Button Battery
381
Climate Control System Maintenance
Dust and Pollen Filter
The climate control system is equipped with a dust and pollen filter that collects
pollen, dust, and other debris in the air. The Maintenance MinderTM messages will let
you know when to replace the filter.
We recommend that you replace the dust and pollen filter sooner when using your
vehicle in areas with high concentrations of dust.
Maintenance
382
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If the airflow from the climate control system
deteriorates noticeably, and the windows fog up
easily, the filter may need to be replaced. Please
contact a dealer for replacement.
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
■ Cleaning Seat Belts
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the openings of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Opening
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle.
Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if
liquids are splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches.
Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or a fire
inside the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discoloration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or gasoline.
■ Cleaning the Window
1Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Continued
Maintenance
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
off using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
383
uuCleaninguInterior Care
■ Floor Mats
Unlock
Lock
1Floor Mats
The front floor mats hook over the floor
anchors, which keep the mats from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn
the anchor knobs to the unlock position.
When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn
the knobs to the lock position.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of
the anchored mat.
■ Maintaining Genuine Leather
Vacuum dirt and dust from the leather frequently. Pay close attention to the pleats
and seams. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a 90% water and
10% neutral soap solution. Then buff it with a clean, dry cloth. Remove any dust or
dirt on leather surfaces immediately.
Maintenance
384
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
■ Washing the Vehicle
1Washing the Vehicle
Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following
conditions:
• If driving on roads with road salt.
• If driving in coastal areas.
• If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
Do not spray water into the air intake vents. It can
cause a malfunction.
■ Using an Automated Car Wash
Fold in the door mirrors.
Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
Air Intake Vents
■ Using High Pressure Cleaners
Continued
Maintenance
• Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
• Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
• Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
385
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Applying Wax
A good coat of automotive body wax helps protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
■ Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
If you get gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they
may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
clean water.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
■ Maintaining Aluminum Wheels
Maintenance
386
Aluminum is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. Use a sponge and mild detergent to wipe away promptly.
Be careful not to use harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or
a stiff brush. They can damage the clear coat of the aluminum alloy wheels that
helps keep the aluminum from corroding and tarnishing.
1Applying Wax
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe up
spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Fogged Exterior Light Lenses
The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights, etc.) may fog temporarily
if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash.
Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant
enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to
vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions).
These conditions are natural processes, not structural design problems in the
exterior lights.
Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame
surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.
However, if you see large amounts water accumulation, or large water drops
building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Maintenance
387
388
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
Tools
Types of Tools .................................. 390
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire * ....................... 391
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire * ..... 397
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine ........................ 408
If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is
Weak ............................................. 409
Emergency Engine Stop ................... 410
Jump Starting.................................... 411
Shift Lever Does Not Move .............. 413
* Not available on all models
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 414
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes
On ............................................. 416
If the Charging System Indicator Comes
On ................................................. 416
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks ................................... 417
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On ...............................418
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Comes On or Blinks ....................... 419
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 420
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 422
Emergency Towing........................... 423
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate..... 424
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes
On ....................................................418
389
Tools
Types of Tools
1Types of Tools
Vehicles with a compact spare tire
The tools are stored in the luggage area.
Jack
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Handling the Unexpected
390
Jack Handle Bar
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire *
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tire with a compact
spare tire. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tire repaired or
replaced.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, non-slippery surface and apply the parking brake.
2. Move the shift lever to (P .
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
1Changing a Flat Tire *
Periodically check the tire pressure of the compact
spare. It should be set to the specified pressure.
Specified Pressure: 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2)
When driving with the compact spare tire, keep the
vehicle speed under 50 mph (80 km/h). Replace with
a full-size tire as soon as possible.
Do not mount tire chains on a compact spare tire.
If a chain-mounted front tire goes flat, remove one of
the full-size rear tires and replace it with the compact
spare tire. Remove the flat front tire and replace it
with the full-size tire that was removed from the rear.
Mount the tire chains on the front tire.
Do not use a puncture-repairing agent on a flat tire,
as it can damage the tire pressure sensor.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
The compact spare tire and wheel in your vehicle are
specifically for this model. Do not use them with
another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact
spare tire or wheel with your vehicle.
391
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire *
■ Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tire
1. Open the cargo area floor lid.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Take the wheel nut wrench and jack handle
bar out of the cargo area.
Spare Tire
3. Unscrew the wing bolt, and remove the
spacer cone. Then, remove the spare tire.
4. Take the jack out of the spare tire area.
392
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire *
5. Place a wheel block or rock in front and rear
of the wheel diagonal to the flat tire.
The tire to be replaced.
Wheel
Blocks
7. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn
using the wheel nut wrench.
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
6. Place the compact spare tire (wheel side up)
under the vehicle body, near the tire that
needs to be replaced.
393
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire *
■ How to Set Up the Jack
1How to Set Up the Jack
1. Place the jack under the jacking point
closest to the tire to be changed.
3 WARNING
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack,
seriously injuring anyone underneath.
Follow the directions for changing a tire
exactly, and never get under the vehicle
when it is supported only by the jack.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Turn the end bracket (as shown in the
image) clockwise until the top of the jack
contacts the jacking point.
u Make sure that the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.
3. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar
and the jack handle, until the tire is off the
ground.
Jack
Handle
Bar
Wheel Nut Wrench as Jack Handle
394
Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the
vehicle.
Use the jack provided in your vehicle.
Other jacks may not support the weight (“load”) or
may not fit the jacking point.
The following instructions must be followed to use
the jack safely:
• Do not use while the engine is running.
• Use only where the ground is firm and level.
• Use only at the jacking points.
• Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
• Do not put anything on top of or underneath the
jack.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire *
■ Replacing the Flat Tire
1Replacing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tire.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel
with a clean cloth.
3. Mount the compact spare tire.
4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the
lips around the mounting holes, then stop
rotating.
Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra
torque using your foot or a pipe.
5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack.
Tighten the wheel nuts in the order
indicated in the image. Go around,
tightening the nuts, two to three times in
this order.
Wheel nut torque:
80 lbf∙ft (108 N∙m, 11 kgf∙m)
Continued
395
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire *
■ Storing the Flat Tire
Wing
Bolt
For normal tire
Spacer
Cone
Handling the Unexpected
For compact spare tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Store the jack in its holder. Turn the jack’s
end bracket to lock it in place.
2. Remove the center cap.
3. Place the flat tire face up in the spare tire
well.
4. Remove the spacer cone from the wing bolt
for the spare tire, and insert the wing bolt
for the normal tire back on the bolt. Secure
the flat tire with the wing bolt.
5. Securely store the wheel nut wrench and
jack handle bar back in the cargo area.
■ TPMS and the Spare Tire
If you replace a flat tire with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on while you are driving. After driving for a few miles (kilometers), the
indicator will start blinking for a short time and then stay on. CHECK TPMS
SYSTEM/Tire Pressure Monitor Problem appears on the multi-information
display, but this is normal.
If you replace the tire with a specified regular tire, the warning message on the
multi-information display and the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will go off after
a few miles (kilometers).
396
3 WARNING
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
1TPMS and the Spare Tire
The system cannot monitor the pressure of the spare
tire. Manually check the spare tire pressure to be sure
that it is correct.
Use the TPMS specific wheels. Each is equipped with
a tire pressure sensor mounted inside the tire behind
the valve stem.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
If the tire has a large cut or is otherwise severely damaged, you will need to have the
vehicle towed. If the tire only has a small puncture, from a nail for instance, you can
use the temporary tire repair kit so that you can drive to the nearest service station
for a more permanent repair.
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then stop in a safe place.
The kit should not be used in the following situations.
Instead, contact a dealer or a roadside assistant to
have the vehicle towed.
• The tire sealant has expired.
• More than one tire is punctured.
• The puncture or cut is larger than 3/16 inch (4mm).
• The tire side wall is damaged or the puncture is
outside the contact area.
Contact
Area
When the puncture is:
Kit Use
Smaller than 3/16 inch
(4 mm)
Yes
Larger than 3/16 inch
(4 mm)
No
• Damage has been caused by driving with the tire
extremely under inflated.
• The tire bead is no longer seated.
• The rim is damaged.
Handling the Unexpected
1. Park the vehicle on a firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking
brake.
2. Move the shift lever to (P .
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
1Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
Do not remove a nail or screw that punctured the
tire. If you remove it from the tire, you may not be
able to repair the puncture using the kit.
NOTICE
Do not use a puncture-repairing agent other than the
one provided in the kit that came with your vehicle. If
a different agent is used, you may permanently
damage the tire pressure sensor.
* Not available on all models
Continued
397
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
■ Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tire
Pressure Gauge
Sealant/Air Hose (Clear)
AIR ONLY side
Inflator Switch
Tire Sealant
Expiration Date
Pressure Relief
Button
Instruction Manual
Power Plug
Selector Switch
SEALANT/AIR side
Handling the Unexpected
Air Only Hose (Black)
Repair Notification Label
Floor lid
Tire Repair Kit
398
Speed Restriction Label
1. Open the cargo area floor lid.
2. Take the kit out of the tool box.
3. Place the kit face up, on flat ground near
the flat tire, and away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
1Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tire
Repair notification label and speed restriction label
are applied to the side of temporary tire repair kit.
When making a temporary repair, carefully read the
instruction manual provided with the kit.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
■ Injecting Sealant and Air
Valve Cap
1Injecting Sealant and Air
1. Remove the valve cap from the tire valve
stem.
3 WARNING
Tire sealant contains substances that are
harmful and can be fatal if swallowed.
If accidentally swallowed, do not induce
vomiting. Drink plenty of water and get
medical attention immediately.
Valve Stem
In cold temperatures, the sealant may not flow easily.
In this situation, warm it up for five minutes before
using.
The sealant can permanently stain clothing and other
materials. Be careful during handling and wipe away
any spills immediately.
Sealant/Air Hose
Handling the Unexpected
2. Remove the sealant/air hose from the
packaging.
Sealant/Air Hose
For skin or eye contact, flush with cool
water and get medical attention if
necessary.
3. Attach the sealant/air hose onto the tire
valve stem. Screw it until it is tight.
Valve Stem
Continued
399
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
4. Plug in the compressor to the accessory
power socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
u Do not plug any other electronic
devices into other accessory power
sockets.
1Injecting Sealant and Air
3 WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
2 Accessory Power Sockets P. 174
Handling the Unexpected
5. Start the engine.
u Keep the engine running while injecting
sealant and air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 62
6. Turn the selector switch to SEALANT/
AIR.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
NOTICE
Do not operate the temporary tire repair kit
compressor for more than 15 minutes. The
compressor can overheat and become permanently
damaged.
SEALANT/AIR side
400
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Until the sealant injection is complete, the pressure
shown on the pressure gauge will appear higher than
actual. After the sealant injection is complete the
pressure will drop and then begin to rise again as the
tire is inflated with air. This is normal. To accurately
measure the air pressure using the gauge, turn the air
compressor off only after the sealant injection is
complete.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
Pressure Gauge
ON
OFF
Valve Stem
1Injecting Sealant and Air
If the required air pressure is not reached within 15
minutes, the tire may be too severely damaged for
the kit to provide the necessary seal and your vehicle
will need to be towed.
See an Acura dealer for a replacement sealant bottle
and proper disposal of an empty bottle.
Handling the Unexpected
Sealant/Air Hose
7. Press the inflator switch to turn on the
compressor.
u The compressor starts injecting sealant
and air into the tire.
8. When the sealant injection is complete,
continue to add air.
9. After the air pressure reaches front: 35 psi
(240 kPa)/rear: 33 psi (230 kPa), turn off
the kit.
u To check the pressure, occasionally turn
off the compressor and read the gauge.
10. Unplug the power plug from the accessory
power socket.
11. Unscrew the sealant/air hose from the tire
valve stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
12. Press the pressure relief button until the
gauge returns to 0 psi (0 kPa).
Pressure Relief Button
Continued
401
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
Repair Notification Label
Handling the Unexpected
■ Distributing the Sealant in the Tire
1. Apply the speed restriction label to the
location as shown.
2. Drive the vehicle for about 10 minutes.
u Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
3. Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
Speed Restriction Label
402
13. Apply the repair notification label to the
flat surface of the wheel.
u The wheel surface must be clean to
ensure the label adheres properly.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
4. Recheck the air pressure using the air only
hose on the compressor.
Air Only Hose
5. Turn the selector switch to AIR ONLY.
u Do not turn the air compressor on to
check the pressure.
2 Inflating an Under-inflated Tire P. 405
ON
6. If the air pressure is
• Less than 19 psi (130 kPa):
Do not add air or continue driving. The leak
is too severe. Call for help and have your
vehicle towed.
2 Emergency Towing P. 423
• Front: 35 psi (240 kPa)/rear: 33 psi (230
kPa) or more:
Continue driving for another 10 minutes or
until you reach the nearest service station.
Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
u If the air pressure does not go down after
the 10 minute driving, you do not need
to check the pressure any more.
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
AIR ONLY
side
403
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
• Greater than 19 psi (130 kPa), but less
than front: 35 psi (240 kPa)/rear: 33 psi
(230 kPa):
Turn the air compressor on to inflate the
tire until the tire pressure reaches front: 35
psi (240 kPa)/rear: 33 psi (230 kPa).
2 Inflating an Under-inflated Tire P. 405
Handling the Unexpected
Then drive carefully for 10 more minutes or
until you reach the nearest service station.
Do not exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
u You should repeat this procedure as long
as the air pressure is within this range.
7. Press the pressure relief button until the
gauge returns to 0 psi (0 kPa).
8. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
Pressure Relief Button
404
1Distributing the Sealant in the Tire
3 WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
■ Inflating an Under-inflated Tire
1Inflating an Under-inflated Tire
NOTICE
You can use the kit to inflate a non-punctured under-inflated tire.
1. Open the cargo area floor lid.
2 Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair
the Flat Tire P. 398
Do not operate the temporary tire repair kit
compressor for more than 15 minutes. The
compressor can overheat and become permanently
damaged.
2. Remove the kit from the case.
3. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near
the flat tire, away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
4. Remove the air only hose from the kit.
Handling the Unexpected
Air Only Hose
5. Remove the valve cap.
Valve Cap
Air Only Hose
6. Attach the air only hose onto the tire valve
stem. Screw it until it is tight.
Valve Stem
Continued
405
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
7. Plug in the kit to the accessory power
socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
u Do not plug any other electronic
devices into other accessory power
sockets.
1Inflating an Under-inflated Tire
3 WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
2 Accessory Power Sockets P. 174
Handling the Unexpected
406
8. Start the engine.
u Keep the engine running while injecting
air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 62
AIR ONLY
side
ON
9. Turn the selector switch to AIR ONLY.
10. Press the inflator switch to turn on the kit.
u The compressor starts to inject air into
the tire.
11. Inflate the tire to the specified air pressure.
Breathing this colorless, odorless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tire *
Pressure Relief Button
Handling the Unexpected
12. Turn off the kit.
u Check the pressure gauge on the air
compressor.
u If overinflated, press the pressure relief
button.
13. Unplug the kit from the accessory power
socket.
14. Unscrew the air only hose from the tire
valve stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
15. Press the pressure relief button until the
gauge returns to 0 psi (0 kPa).
16. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
407
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine
If the engine does not start, check the starter.
1Checking the Engine
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 411
Handling the Unexpected
Starter condition
Starter doesn’t turn or turns
over slowly.
The battery may be dead. Check
each of the items on the right and
respond accordingly.
Checklist
Check for a message on the multi-information display.
● If the TO START, HOLD REMOTE NEAR START BUTTON/To Start, Hold Remote Near Start
Button message appears
2 If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is Weak P. 409
uMake sure the keyless access remote is in its operating range.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button P. 144
Check brightness of the interior lights.
Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.
● If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at all
2 Battery P. 379
If the interior lights come on normally 2 Fuses P. 420
Review the engine start procedure.
Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again. 2 Starting the Engine P. 268
Check the immobilizer system indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.
●
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with the
fuse. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
2 Immobilizer System P. 137
Check the fuel level.
There should be enough fuel in the tank. 2 Fuel Gauge P. 93
Check the fuse.
Check all fuses, or have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 422
If the problem continues:
2 Emergency Towing P. 423
408
uuEngine Does Not StartuIf the Keyless Access Remote Battery is Weak
If the Keyless Access Remote Battery is Weak
If the beeper sounds, the TO START, HOLD REMOTE NEAR START BUTTON/To
Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message appears on the multi-information
display, the indicator on the ENGINE START/STOP button flashes, and the engine
won’t start, start the engine as follows.
1. Touch the center of the ENGINE START/
STOP button with the A logo on the keyless
access remote while the indicator on the
ENGINE START/STOP button is flashing.
The buttons on the keyless access remote
should be facing you.
u The indicator flashes for about 30
seconds.
HOLD
Handling the Unexpected
2. Depress the brake pedal and press the
ENGINE START/STOP button within 10
seconds after the beeper sounds and the
indicator changes from flashing to on.
u If you don’t depress the pedal, the mode
will change to ACCESSORY.
409
uuEngine Does Not StartuEmergency Engine Stop
Emergency Engine Stop
The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an
emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the
following operations:
• Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for two seconds.
• Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice.
Handling the Unexpected
410
The steering wheel will not lock. However, because turning off the engine disables
the power assist the engine provides to the steering and braking systems, it will
require significantly more physical effort and time to steer and slow the vehicle. Use
both feet on the brake pedal to slow down the vehicle and stop immediately in a
safe place.
The power mode is in ACCESSORY when the engine is stopped.
To change the mode to VEHICLE OFF, change the gear position to (P after the
vehicle comes to a complete stop. Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button
twice without depressing the brake pedal.
1Emergency Engine Stop
Do not press the button while driving unless it is
absolutely necessary for the engine to be switched
off.
Jump Starting
■ Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine,
then open the hood.
1. Connect the first jumper cable to your
vehicle’s battery + terminal.
2. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
3. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
4. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the engine hanger as
shown. Do not connect this jumper cable to
any other part.
5. If your vehicle is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle’s engine
and increase its rpm slightly.
6. Attempt to start your vehicle’s engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
Continued
A battery can explode if you do not follow
the correct procedure, seriously injuring
anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and
may prevent the engine from starting.
Handling the Unexpected
Booster Battery
3 WARNING
411
uuJump Startingu
■ What to Do After the Engine Starts
Once your vehicle’s engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order.
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s ground.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the assisting vehicle’s terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the assisting vehicle’s +
terminal.
Handling the Unexpected
412
Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.
Shift Lever Does Not Move
Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the (P
position.
■ Releasing the Lock
Slot
Cover
Release Button
4. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.
5. While pushing the key down, press the shift
lever release button and place the shift lever
into (N .
u The lock is now released. Have the shift
lever checked by a dealer as soon as
possible.
Handling the Unexpected
1. Set the parking brake.
2. Remove the built-in key from the keyless
access remote.
3. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flattip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock
release slot as shown in the image, and
remove the cover.
Shift Lock Release Slot
413
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
• The temperature gauge needle is at the H mark or the engine suddenly loses
power.
• Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
■ First thing to do
Handling the Unexpected
414
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the hood.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.
Then, open the hood.
1How to Handle Overheating
3 WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam is coming
out.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the temperature gauge
needle at the H mark may damage the engine.
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
■ Next thing to do
1How to Handle Overheating
MAX
Reserve Tank
MIN
■ Last thing to do
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
Handling the Unexpected
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
stop the engine once the temperature
gauge needle comes down.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately stop the engine.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the reserve tank is
low, add coolant until it reaches the
MAX mark.
u If there is no coolant in the reserve tank,
check that the radiator is cool. Cover the
radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open
the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to
the base of the filler neck, and put the
cap back on.
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the temperature gauge.
If the temperature needle has gone down, resume driving. If it has not gone down,
contact a dealer for repairs.
415
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
Handling the Unexpected
416
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.
■ What to do as soon as the indicator comes on
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about one minute.
2. Open the hood and check the oil level.
u Add oil as necessary.
3. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure indicator.
u The indicator goes off: Start driving again.
u The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Stop the
engine and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.
1If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the battery is not being charged.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Turn off the climate control system, rear defogger, and other electrical
systems, and immediately contact a dealer for repairs.
1If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the
engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge
the battery.
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
■ Tighten Fuel Cap Message
■ The message appears on when:
An evaporative system leak is detected. This may be caused by the fuel fill cap being
loose or not being installed.
■ What to do when the message appears:
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when
restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at
31 mph (50 km/h) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
Handling the Unexpected
• Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system, or the fuel fill cap is missing, or loose.
• Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
ten minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
1. Stop the engine.
2. Check that the fuel fill cap is fully installed.
u If not, loosen the cap, and then retighten it until it clicks at least once.
3. Drive for several days of normal driving.
u The message should go off.
■ When the malfunction indicator lamp comes on
Malfunction indicator lamp comes on if the system continues to detect a leak of
gasoline vapor. If this happens, check the fuel fill cap using the procedures described
above.
417
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
U.S.
Canada
Handling the Unexpected
418
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• The brake fluid is low.
• There is a malfunction in the brake system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Press the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
• If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
• If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• Comes on when there is a problem with EPS system.
• If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine
speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and
sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary downshift
the gears.
If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come
on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution
system is not working. This can result in vehicle
instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or
Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on or blink
* Not available on all models
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tire can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tire can fail. Always
inflate your tires to the prescribed level.
Handling the Unexpected
A tire pressure is significantly low. If there is a problem with the TPMS or
the compact spare tire * is installed, the indicator blinks for about one
minute, and then stays on.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tire pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tire pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
■ What to do when the indicator blinks
Have the tire inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact
spare tire * causes the indicator to blink, change the tire to a full-size tire.
The indicator goes off after driving for a few miles (kilometers).
1If the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator Comes On or Blinks
419
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working, set
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
and check to see if any applicable fuse is
blown.
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
■ Engine Compartment Fuse Box
Handling the Unexpected
Located near the brake fluid reservoir. Push
the tabs to open the box.
2
Tab
3
4
5
6
7
8
420
* Not available on all models
Circuit Protected
EPS
Power Tailgate Motor
ABS/VSA FSR
ABS/VSA Motor
E-DPS
Main Fuse
−
Fuse Box Main 1
Fuse Box Main 2
IG Main
Headlight Washer *
Sub Fan Motor
Rear Defogger
Main Fan Motor
Headlight Main
Blower
ST CUT1
IG Main1
Sub Fuse Main
IG Main2
Rear Seat Heaters *
STR Diagnosis Fuse
Audio (ODMD) *
−
−
Amps
70 A
(40 A)
20 A
40 A
(30 A)
120 A
50 A
60 A
60 A
50 A
(30 A)
30 A
40 A
30 A
30 A
40 A
40 A
30 A
(40 A)
30 A
(20 A)
7.5 A
(15 A)
−
−
Circuit Protected
9
−
10
−
11
Oil Level
12
Fog Lights *
13
Power Tailgate Closer
14
Hazard
15
IGP2
16
IG Coil
17
Stop
18
Horn
19
ACM
20 Right Headlight Low Beam
21
MG Clutch
22
DBW
23 Left Headlight Low Beam
24
DRL
25
FI Main
26
Trailer
27
Small
28
Interior Lights
29
Back Up
Amps
−
−
7.5 A
(20 A)
(20 A)
10 A
15 A
15 A
10 A
10 A
20 A
15 A
7.5 A
15 A
15 A
(10 A)
15 A
(20 A)
20 A
7.5 A
10 A
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Box
Located under the dashboard.
26
Audio Amp
9
Fuse Box
10
11
12
13
14
15
Fuse Label
Fuse locations are shown on the label on
the side panel.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Circuit Protected
−
ACG
ODS
Fuel Pump
Meter
Rear Wiper
VB SOL
Front Right Side
Door Lock Motor (Unlock)
Amps
−
15 A
7.5 A
15 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
27
28
29
Accessory Power Socket
(Front)
−
SRS
Amps
15 A
30
7.5 A
20 A
31
32
20 A
15 A
20 A
10 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
7.5 A
(10 A)
20 A*1
30 A*2
20 A
−
10 A
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
Circuit Protected
Driver’s Door Lock Motor
(Lock)
Smart
Front Right Side
Door Lock Motor (Lock)
Rear Left Side
Door Lock Motor (Lock)
Small Lights
Illumination
Rear Wiper Main
Passenger’s Power Seat
Reclining
Left Headlight High Beam
Right Headlight High Beam
−
Door Lock
Driver’s Power Window
Rear Right Side Power
Window
Front Right Side Power
Window
Rear Left Side Power
Window
Wiper
Amps
10 A
10 A
15 A
15 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
20 A
10 A
10 A
−
20 A
20 A
Handling the Unexpected
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Circuit Protected
Rear Left Side
Door Lock Motor (Unlock)
Power Lumbar
Moonroof
Accessory Power Socket
(Center Console)
Washer Main
Seat Heaters
Driver’s Door Lock Motor
(Unlock)
Driver’s Power Seat Sliding
Driver’s Power Seat Reclining
Passenger’s Power Seat Sliding
ACC
ACC Key Lock
Daytime Running Lights
A/C
Option
ABS/VSA
IDAS
20 A
20 A
20 A
30 A
*1:Models without navigation system
*2:Models with navigation system
421
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
Blown Fuse
Combined
Fuse
Handling the Unexpected
422
Fuse Puller
1. Set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK). Turn headlights and all accessories
off.
2. Remove the fuse box cover.
3. Check the large fuse in the engine
compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
4. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a burned out fuse, remove it
with the fuse puller and replace it with a
new one.
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a spare fuse of the same specified
amperage
Confirm the specified amperage using the charts on
P. 420 to P. 421.
There is a fuse puller on the back of the engine
compartment fuse box cover.
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
All models
■ Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle’s weight.
NOTICE
2WD models
■ Wheel lift equipment
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
Handling the Unexpected
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tires and lift them off
the ground. The rear tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
Improper towing such as towing behind a
motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the
transmission.
423
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
■ What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure.
1. Use a flat-tip screwdriver and remove the
cover on the inside of the tailgate.
1What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
What to do-following up
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have the
vehicle checked.
When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure
there is enough space around the tailgate, and it
does not hit anyone or any object.
Handling the Unexpected
Cover
2. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate
while sliding the lever to the right using a
flat-tip screwdriver.
u Do not use your finger to slide the lever.
Lever
424
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle’s specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications .................................... 426
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number and Transmission
Number ......................................... 428
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ....... 429
Reporting Safety Defects ................. 430
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes.............. 431
Warranty Coverages ........................ 433
Authorized Manuals......................... 435
Client Service Information ............... 436
425
Specifications
■ Vehicle Specifications
■ Engine Specifications
Model
No. of Passengers:
Front
Rear
Total
Weights:
Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating
Displacement
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Front)
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Rear)
Information
426
Acura RDX
Spark Plugs
2
3
5
U.S.:
Canada:
U.S.:
Canada:
U.S.:
211.8 cu-in (3,471 cm3)
NGK
ILZKR7B11
DENSO
SXU22HCR11
■ Fuel
4,850 lbs (2,200 kg)*1
4,982 lbs (2,260 kg)*2
2,260 kg
2,557 lbs (1,160 kg)*1
2,623 lbs (1,190 kg)*2
1,190 kg
2,293 lbs (1,040 kg)*1
2,381 lbs (1,080 kg)*2
1,080 kg
6,349 lbs (2,880 kg)*1
6,482 lbs (2,940 kg)*2
2,940 kg
Canada:
Gross Combined Weight U.S.:
Rating
Canada:
Air Conditioning:
Refrigerant Type
HFC-134a (R-134a)
Charge Quantity
15.2 – 16.9 oz (430 – 480 g)
Lubricant Type
ND-OIL8
*1: 2WD models
*2: AWD models
Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
Unleaded premium gasoline, Pump octane
number of 91 or higher
16 US gal (60.5 ℓ)
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
U.S.: 2.6 US qt (2.5 ℓ)
Canada: 5.1 US qt (4.85 ℓ)
■ Light Bulbs
Headlights (High Beams)
Headlights (Low Beams)
Fog Lights *
Front Turn Signal/Parking Lights/
Daytime running light
Side Turn Signal Lights
(on Door Mirrors)
Front Side Marker Lights
Rear Side Marker/Brake/Taillights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Turn Signal Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Rear License Plate Light
Cargo Area Lights
Vanity Mirror Lights
Interior Lights
Map Lights
Ceiling Light
Door Courtesy Lights
Console Compartment Light
Glove Box Light
Center Pocket Light
LED
LED
3CP
LED
16W
21W (Amber)
LED
5W
5W
1.4W
LED
8W
2CP
1.4W
1.4W
LED
■ Brake Fluid
Specified
* Not available on all models
LED
LED
55W (H11)
Acura Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
uuSpecificationsu
■ Automatic Transmission Fluid
■ Engine Oil
Specified
Capacity
Recommended
Acura Automatic Transmission Fluid ATF DW-1
Change
3.3 US qt (3.1 ℓ)
■ Rear Differential Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
■ Transfer Assembly Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Capacity
Acura DPSF-II
Change
1.32 US qt (1.25 ℓ)
Acura Hypoid Gear Oil HGO-11
Change
0.43 US qt (0.41 ℓ)
■ Tire
·Genuine Acura Motor Oil 0W-20
·API Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
Change
4.2 US qt (4.0 ℓ)
Change
including
4.5 US qt (4.3 ℓ)
filter
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
Capacity
Regular
Compact
Spare *
Wheel Size
Size
Pressure
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2])
Size
Pressure
psi (kPa[kgf/cm2])
Regular
Compact Spare *
P235/60R18 102V
Front
35 (240 [2.4])
Rear
33 (230 [2.3])
T165/90R17 105M
60 (420 [4.2])
18 x 7.5J
17 x 4T
Acura Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
50/50 with distilled water
1.96 US gal (7.4 ℓ)
(change including the remaining 0.193 US gal
(0.73 ℓ) in the reserve tank)
Information
* Not available on all models
427
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number
and Transmission Number
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle.
The locations of your vehicle’s VIN, engine number and transmission number are
shown as follows.
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number and
Transmission Number
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Vehicle Identification Number
Engine Number
Cover
Automatic Transmission
Number
Certification Label/
Vehicle Identification Number
Information
428
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
The following products and systems on your vehicle emit radio waves when in operation.
AcuraLink *
Audio System
Blind spot information (BSI) System *
Bluetooth® Audio
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM*
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
Immobilizer System
Remote Transmitter
Keyless Access System
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Remote Engine Start with Vehicle Feedback *
Each of the above complies with the appropriate requirements or the required standards of
FCC (Federal Communications Commission) and Industry Canada Standard, described below:
Information
As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with Industry Canada Standard RSS-Gen//210/251/310. Operation is subject to
the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
* Not available on all models
429
Reporting Safety Defects
In the U.S.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists
in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-4249153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://
www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may also inform Transport Canada.
Information
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall and remedy campaign. However, Transport Canada
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For
more information on reporting safety defects or about motor vehicle safety, go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
430
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has “Readiness Codes,” as part of the onboard self diagnostic system.
Some States use these codes as a test to see if your vehicle’s emissions components
are working properly.
The codes may not be read properly if testing is performed just after the battery has
gone dead or been disconnected.
To check if they are set, set the power mode to ON, without starting the engine. The
malfunction indicator lamp will come on for several seconds. If it then goes off, the
readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are not set.
1Testing of Readiness Codes
The readiness codes are erased when the battery is
disconnected, and set again only after several days of
driving under a variety of conditions.
If a testing facility determines that the readiness
codes are not set, you may be requested to return at
a later date to complete the test.
If the testing facility determines the readiness codes
are still not set, see a dealer.
If you are required to have your vehicle tested before the readiness codes are ready,
prepare the vehicle for retesting by doing the following:
Continued
Information
1. Fill the gas tank to approximately 3/4 full.
2. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 6 hours or more.
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40°F and 95°F (4°C and 35°C).
4. Start the engine without touching the accelerator pedal, and let it idle for 20
seconds.
5. Keep the vehicle in (P . Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there
for about 3 minutes.
6. Let the engine idle with your foot off the accelerator for 20 seconds.
431
uuEmissions TestinguTesting of Readiness Codes
7. Select a nearby, lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed
of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in
(D . Do not use cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without
moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you
cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for
at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
8. Drive in city/suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions
allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal
or the brake pedal.
9. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 30 minutes.
Information
432
Warranty Coverages
■ U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty – covers your new vehicle, except for the
emissions control systems and accessories, against defects in materials and
workmanship.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance
Warranty – these two warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems.
Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for
exact information.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty – a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered
by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty – all exterior body panels are covered for
rust-through from the inside for the specified time period with no mileage limit.
Information
Accessory Limited Warranty – Acura accessories are covered under this warranty.
Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other factors. Please
read your warranty booklet for details.
Replacement Parts Limited Warranty – covers all Acura replacement parts
against defects in materials and workmanship.
Continued
433
uuWarranty Coveragesu
Replacement Battery Limited Warranty – provides prorated coverage for a
replacement battery purchased from a dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty – provides coverage for as
long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the Acura
warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on
warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer.
Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet.
■ Canadian Owners
Please refer to the warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
Information
434
Authorized Manuals
■ Service Express
For electronic copies of service publications, you can purchase a subscription to
Service Express. Visit www.techinfo.honda.com for pricing and options.
■ For U.S. Owners:
Manuals can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order a manual by
phone at (800) 782-4356 (credit card orders only), or online at www.helminc.com.
■ For Canadian Owners:
Please contact a dealer to order any manuals that you may require.
Information
435
Client Service Information
Acura dealer personnel are trained professionals.
They should be able to answer all your questions. If you encounter a problem that
your dealership does not solve to your satisfaction, please discuss it with the
dealership’s service manager or general manager. If you are dissatisfied with the
decision made by the dealership’s management, contact Acura Client Relations/
Services.
U.S. Owners:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Acura Client Relations
Mail Stop 500-2N-7E
1919 Torrance Blvd.
Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 382-2238
Information
436
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands:
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
Canadian Owners:
Honda Canada Inc.
Acura Client Services
180 Honda Boulevard
Markham, ON
L6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-ACURA-9
Fax: 1-877-939-0909
E-Mail: [email protected]
1Client Service Information
When you call or write, please give us the following
information:
• Vehicle Identification Number
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number and Transmission
Number P. 428
• Date of purchase
• Odometer reading of your vehicle
• Your name, address, and telephone number
• A detailed description of the problem
• Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
Index
Index
A
USB Flash Drives ...................................... 221
USB Port.................................................. 187
Audio/Information Screen ....................... 191
Authorized Manuals ................................ 435
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking................. 130
Customize....................................... 105, 112
Automatic Intermittent Wipers............... 152
Automatic Lighting .................................. 148
Automatic Transmission........................... 274
Creeping ................................................. 274
Fluid........................................................ 356
Kickdown................................................ 274
Operating the Shift Lever................... 16, 276
Sequential Shift Mode ............................. 277
Shift Lever Does Not Move ...................... 413
Shifting ................................................... 275
Auxiliary Input Jack.................................. 187
Average Fuel Economy .............................. 98
Average Speed ........................................... 99
AWD.......................................................... 310
B
Battery ...................................................... 379
Charging System Indicator................. 68, 416
Jump Starting.......................................... 411
Maintenance (Checking the Battery)........ 379
Belts (Seat) .................................................. 29
Beverage Holders ..................................... 173
Blind spot information (BSI) System........ 307
Bluetooth® Audio ..................................... 213
Index
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System).................. 316
Accessories and Modifications ................ 338
Accessory Power Sockets ......................... 174
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC).......... 79, 284
Additives
Coolant .................................................. 354
Engine Oil ............................................... 349
Washer ................................................... 358
Additives, Engine Oil ............................... 349
Adjusting
Armrest .................................................. 168
Front Seats.............................................. 162
Head Restraints....................................... 164
Mirrors.................................................... 159
Rear Seats............................................... 167
Steering Wheel ....................................... 158
Temperature ............................................. 98
Air Conditioning System
(Climate Control System) ....................... 180
Changing the Mode................................ 180
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows .............................................. 181
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 382
Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode................... 180
Sensors ................................................... 183
Synchronized Mode ................................ 182
Using Automatic Climate Control............ 180
Air Pressure ...................................... 371, 427
Airbags ........................................................ 37
Advanced Airbags ..................................... 43
After a Collision......................................... 40
Airbag Care ............................................... 49
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 40
Indicator .............................................. 47, 70
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator .................. 48
Sensors...................................................... 37
Side Airbags .............................................. 44
Side Curtain Airbags .................................. 46
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent
Control System ........................................ 310
AM/FM Radio ............................................ 198
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 316
Indicator .................................................... 69
Armrest ..................................................... 168
Audio Remote Controls............................ 189
Audio System ............................................ 186
Adjusting the Sound ................................ 197
Auxiliary Input Jack .................................. 187
Error Messages ........................................ 215
General Information ................................ 218
iPod® ....................................................... 205
MP3/WMA/AAC ...................................... 210
Pandora® ................................................. 208
Reactivating............................................. 188
Recommended CDs ................................. 219
Recommended Devices ............................ 221
Remote Controls ..................................... 189
Security Code .......................................... 188
Theft Protection....................................... 188
437
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® ..................... 224
Booster Seats (For Children)....................... 61
Brake System............................................. 314
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ................... 316
Brake Assist System ................................. 317
Fluid ........................................................ 357
Foot Brake ............................................... 315
Indicator ............................................ 66, 418
Parking Brake .......................................... 314
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) .... 154
BSI (Blind spot information) System ........ 307
Bulb Replacement..................................... 359
Back-Up Light and Taillight ...................... 364
Brake Light/Taillight/Rear Side Marker Light and
Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs................... 362
Fog Lights................................................ 359
Front Turn Signal Light/Parking Light/
Daytime Running Light and
Front Side Marker Light Bulbs ................ 361
Headlights ............................................... 359
High-Mount Brake Light .......................... 365
Rear License Plate Light............................ 365
Side Turn Signal Light/Emergency Indicator
Light ...................................................... 360
Bulb Specifications.................................... 426
Index
C
Carbon Monoxide Gas................................ 62
Cargo Hook ............................................... 175
Carrying Cargo.................................. 257, 259
438
CD Player................................................... 202
Certification Label.................................... 428
Changing Bulbs ........................................ 359
Charging System Indicator................. 68, 416
Child Safety................................................. 50
Childproof Door Locks............................. 129
Child Seat.................................................... 50
Booster Seats ............................................ 61
Child Seat for Infants................................. 52
Child Seat for Small Children..................... 53
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/
Shoulder Seat Belt ................................... 57
Larger Children ......................................... 60
Rear-facing Child Seat ............................... 52
Selecting a Child Seat................................ 54
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 129
Cleaning the Exterior ............................... 385
Cleaning the Interior................................ 383
Client Service Information ....................... 436
Climate Control System............................ 180
Changing the Mode ................................ 180
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows............................................... 181
Dust and Pollen Filter............................... 382
Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode ................... 180
Sensors ................................................... 183
Synchronized Mode................................. 182
Using Automatic Climate Control ............ 180
Clock.......................................................... 118
CMBSTM (Collision Mitigation Braking
SystemTM)................................................. 318
Coat Hook ................................................ 175
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ................................................. 318
Compact Spare Tire.......................... 391, 427
Compass.................................................... 253
Console Compartment............................. 172
Controls .................................................... 117
Coolant (Engine) ...................................... 354
Adding to the Radiator ........................... 355
Adding to the Reserve Tank .................... 354
Overheating............................................ 414
Creeping (Automatic Transmission)........ 274
Cross Traffic Monitor ............................... 331
Cruise Control .......................................... 279
Indicator ................................................... 76
Cup Holders .............................................. 173
Customized Features ....................... 100, 106
D
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 150
Dead Battery ............................................ 411
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows ................................................. 181
Detachable Anchor .................................... 34
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ............... 429
Dimming
Headlights .............................................. 147
Rearview Mirror ...................................... 159
Dipstick (Engine Oil) ................................ 350
Directional Signals (Turn Signal) ............. 147
Display Button.......................................... 191
Door Mirrors............................................. 160
Doors ........................................................ 119
Auto Door Locking.................................. 130
Auto Door Unlocking .............................. 130
Door and Tailgate Open Indicator ............. 72
Door and Tailgate Open Message ............. 87
Keys........................................................ 119
Locking/Unlocking the Doors
from the Inside...................................... 128
Locking/Unlocking the Doors
from the Outside................................... 123
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 126
DOT Tire Quality Grading........................ 373
Driving ...................................................... 255
Automatic Transmission .......................... 274
Braking ................................................... 314
Cruise Control ........................................ 279
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines .............. 266
Shifting Gear .......................................... 275
Starting the Engine ................................. 268
Driving Position Memory System ............ 156
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 382
Elapsed Time .............................................. 99
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator ........................................... 72, 418
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) ............ 305
Emergency................................................ 423
F
Features .................................................... 185
Filters
Dust and Pollen ....................................... 382
Oil........................................................... 352
Flat Tire ............................................. 391, 397
Floor Mats................................................. 384
Fluids
Automatic Transmission .......................... 356
Brake ...................................................... 357
Engine Coolant ....................................... 354
Windshield Washer ................................. 358
Fog Light Indicator..................................... 74
Folding Down the Rear Seats .................. 167
Foot Brake ................................................ 315
Front Airbags (SRS)..................................... 40
Front Seats ................................................ 162
Adjusting ................................................ 162
Front Sensor Camera................................ 282
Fuel...................................................... 17, 335
Economy ................................................. 337
Gauge....................................................... 93
Instant Fuel Economy ................................ 98
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 69
Range ....................................................... 99
Recommendation .................................... 335
Refueling................................................. 335
Fuel Economy ........................................... 337
Fuel Fill Cap ........................................ 17, 336
Message.................................................. 417
Fuel Fill Door ...................................... 17, 336
Index
E
Emissions Testing (Readiness Codes) ....... 431
Engine ....................................................... 428
Coolant ................................................... 354
Jump Starting .......................................... 411
Oil ........................................................... 349
Remote Engine Start ................................ 270
Starting ................................................... 268
Engine Coolant ......................................... 354
Adding to the Radiator ............................ 355
Adding to the Reserve Tank ..................... 354
Overheating ............................................ 414
Temperature Gauge .................................. 93
Engine Oil ................................................. 349
Adding .................................................... 351
Checking ................................................. 350
Displaying Oil Life .................................... 343
Low Oil Pressure Indicator.................. 67, 416
Recommended Engine Oil........................ 349
ENGINE START/STOP Button .................... 144
EPS (Electric Power Steering)
System ............................................... 72, 418
Exhaust Gas Hazard
(Carbon Monoxide) .................................. 62
Exterior Care (Cleaning) ........................... 385
Exterior Mirrors ........................................ 160
439
Fuses .......................................................... 420
Inspecting and Changing ......................... 422
Locations ......................................... 420, 421
G
Gasoline (Fuel)
Economy ................................................. 337
Gauge ....................................................... 93
Information ............................................. 335
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 69
Refueling ................................................. 335
Gauges......................................................... 93
Gear Shift Lever Positions
Automatic Transmission........................... 275
Glass (care) ................................................ 386
Glove Box .................................................. 171
Options During a Call .............................. 247
Phone Setup............................................ 231
Receiving a Call ....................................... 246
Speed Dial............................................... 241
Text Message .................................. 236, 248
To Clear the System ................................ 239
To Create a Security PIN .......................... 237
Hazard Warning Button .............................. 4
Head Restraints ........................................ 164
Headlights................................................. 147
Automatic Operation............................... 148
Dimming ......................................... 147, 150
Operating................................................ 147
Heaters (Seat) ........................... 177, 178, 179
HFL (HandsFreeLink®)............................... 224
High Beam Indicator .................................. 73
Hill Start Assist System ............................. 272
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver............ 222
H
Index
440
Halogen Bulbs........................................... 359
Handling the Unexpected ........................ 389
HandsFreeLink® (HFL) ............................... 224
Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and
Call History ............................................ 240
Automatic Transferring ............................ 238
Caller’s ID Information ............................. 238
HFL Buttons ............................................. 224
HFL Menus .............................................. 226
HFL Status Display.................................... 225
Making a Call .......................................... 243
I
Identification Numbers ............................ 428
Engine and Transmission ......................... 428
Vehicle Identification ............................... 428
Illumination Control................................. 154
Knob....................................................... 154
Immobilizer System .................................. 137
Indicator.................................................... 74
Indicators.................................................... 66
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC).......... 79, 284
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) with Intelligent Control
System .................................................... 70
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................... 69
Blind spot information (BSI) System ........... 77
Brake System ............................................ 66
Charging System............................... 68, 416
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) .......................................... 80, 81
CRUISE CONTROL ............................. 76, 280
CRUISE MAIN.................................... 76, 279
Door and Tailgate Open............................ 72
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System ............................................ 72, 418
Fog Light .................................................. 74
High Beam................................................ 73
Immobilizer System ................................... 74
Keyless Access System............................... 76
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) ................ 78
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) ... 79, 299
Lights On .................................................. 74
Low Fuel ................................................... 69
Low Oil Pressure ............................... 67, 416
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS ............................ 73
Malfunction Indicator Lamp .............. 67, 417
Parking Brake and Brake System ....... 66, 418
Seat Belt Reminder.............................. 30, 69
Security System Alarm............................... 75
Shift Lever Position.................................... 68
Supplemental Restraint System ........... 47, 70
System Message ....................................... 75
Transmission ............................................. 68
Turn Signal ............................................... 73
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®)
System ............................................ 71, 305
VSA® OFF.......................................... 71, 306
Information .............................................. 425
Instrument Panel........................................ 65
Brightness Control .................................. 154
Interior Lights........................................... 169
Interior Rearview Mirror ......................... 159
iPod® ......................................................... 205
J
Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench)........................ 394
Jump Starting........................................... 411
K
L
Lane Departure Warning (LDW).............. 293
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) ......... 297
Language (HFL)......................................... 225
LATCH (Child Seats) .............................. 55, 58
LDW (Lane Departure Warning).............. 293
Lights................................................. 147, 359
Automatic ............................................... 148
Bulb Replacement.................................... 359
Daytime Running Lights ........................... 150
Fog Lights................................................ 150
High Beam Indicator .................................. 73
Interior .................................................... 169
Light Switches ......................................... 147
Lights On Indicator .................................... 74
Turn Signals............................................. 147
Load Limits ................................................ 259
Locking/Unlocking .................................... 119
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking .................. 130
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 129
From Inside.............................................. 128
From Outside........................................... 123
Keys ........................................................ 119
Using a Key ............................................. 126
Lockout Prevention System...................... 126
Low Battery Charge.................................. 416
Low Fuel Indicator ...................................... 69
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 67, 416
Lower Anchors...................................... 55, 58
Luggage (Maximum Load Limit) ............. 259
Lumbar Support ....................................... 162
M
Maintenance............................................. 339
Battery .................................................... 379
Brake Fluid .............................................. 357
Cleaning ................................................. 383
Climate Control System........................... 382
Coolant................................................... 354
Maintenance MinderTM ............................ 343
Oil........................................................... 350
Precautions ............................................. 340
Radiator .................................................. 355
Remote Transmitter......................... 380, 381
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 359
Safety...................................................... 341
Service Items ........................................... 345
Tires ........................................................ 370
Transmission Fluid ................................... 356
Under the Hood ...................................... 347
Malfunction Indicator Lamp.............. 67, 417
Map Lights ................................................ 169
Maximum Load Limit ............................... 259
Meters, Gauges........................................... 93
Index
Key Number Tag ...................................... 121
Keyless Access System .............................. 123
Keyless Lockout Prevention..................... 126
Keys........................................................... 119
Lockout Prevention ................................. 126
Number Tag............................................ 121
Rear Door Won’t Open ........................... 129
Remote Transmitter ................................ 125
Two-way Keyless Access
Remote ................................. 119, 127, 270
Types and Functions................................ 119
Kickdown (Automatic Transmission) ....... 274
441
Mirrors....................................................... 159
Adjusting................................................. 159
Door........................................................ 160
Exterior.................................................... 160
Interior Rearview...................................... 159
Modifications (and Accessories)............... 338
Moonroof.................................................. 143
MP3.................................................... 202, 210
Multi-Information Display.......................... 94
Multi-View Rear Camera .......................... 334
N
Numbers (Identification) .......................... 428
O
Index
442
Odometer.................................................... 97
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines.............. 266
Oil (Engine) ............................................... 349
Adding .................................................... 351
Checking ................................................. 350
Displaying Oil Life .................................... 343
Low Oil Pressure Indicator.................. 67, 416
Recommended Engine Oil................ 349, 427
Viscosity .......................................... 349, 427
On Demand Multi-Use DisplayTM ................. 4
Opening/Closing
Hood ....................................................... 348
Moonroof................................................ 143
Power Windows ...................................... 140
Tailgate ................................................... 131
Outside Temperature Display.................... 98
Overheating.............................................. 414
P
Paddle Shifters
(Sequential Shift Mode) ......................... 277
Pandora®................................................... 208
Panic Mode ............................................... 139
Parking...................................................... 326
Parking Brake ........................................... 314
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator............................................ 66, 418
Parking Sensor System ............................. 327
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator ................. 48
Passing Indicators ..................................... 147
Power Tailgate ......................................... 133
Power Windows ....................................... 140
Precautions While Driving ....................... 273
Driving Guidelines for Your Utility
Vehicle .................................................. 273
Rain ........................................................ 273
Pregnant Women ....................................... 35
Puncture (Tire).................................. 391, 397
R
Radiator .................................................... 355
Radio (AM/FM) ......................................... 198
Radio (SiriusXM®) ..................................... 200
Radio Data System (RDS) ......................... 199
Range.......................................................... 99
RDS (Radio Data System) ......................... 199
Readiness Codes (Emissions Testing) ...... 431
Rear Defogger/
Heated Door Mirror Button .................. 155
Rear Seat Heaters..................................... 179
Rear Seats (Folding Down) ...................... 167
Rearview Mirror ....................................... 159
Refueling .................................................. 335
Fuel Gauge ............................................... 93
Gasoline ......................................... 335, 426
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 69
Regulations .............................. 312, 373, 429
Remote Engine Start with Vehicle
Feedback................................................. 270
Remote Transmitter ................................. 125
Replacement
Battery............................................ 380, 381
Bulbs ...................................................... 359
Front Wiper Blade Rubber ....................... 366
Fuses .............................................. 420, 421
Rear Wiper Blade Rubber ........................ 368
Tires........................................................ 376
Reporting Safety Defects......................... 430
Resetting a Trip Meter............................... 98
Reverse Tilt Door Mirror .......................... 160
S
Synchronized Mode ................................. 182
System Message Indicator.......................... 75
T
Tachometer................................................. 93
Tailgate ..................................................... 131
Unable to Open....................................... 424
Temperature
Outside Temperature Display..................... 98
Temperature Gauge................................... 93
Temperature Sensor........................... 98, 183
Temporary Tire Repair Kit ....................... 398
Text Message .................................... 236, 248
Time (Setting) ........................................... 118
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) ..................................................... 310
Indicator............................................ 73, 419
Tire Repair Kit........................................... 397
Tires........................................................... 370
Air Pressure ..................................... 371, 427
Checking and Maintaining ...................... 370
Inspection ............................................... 370
Labeling .................................................. 371
Puncture (Flat Tire) .......................... 391, 397
Regulations ............................................. 373
Rotation .................................................. 377
Spare Tire........................................ 391, 427
Summer .................................................. 378
Temporary Tire Repair Kit ........................ 398
Tire Chains .............................................. 378
Index
Safe Driving................................................ 23
Safety Check............................................... 28
Safety Labels .............................................. 63
Safety Message ............................................ 1
Seat Belts .................................................... 29
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor ................. 33
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................. 31
Checking .................................................. 36
Detachable Anchor ................................... 34
Fastening .................................................. 32
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/
Shoulder Seat Belt................................... 57
Pregnant Women...................................... 35
Reminder .................................................. 30
Warning Indicator ............................... 30, 69
Seat Heaters ............................................. 177
Seats.......................................................... 162
Adjusting ................................................ 162
Front Seats.............................................. 162
Lumbar Support...................................... 162
Rear Seats............................................... 167
Seat Heaters ........................... 177, 178, 179
Security System ........................................ 137
Immobilizer System Indicator..................... 74
Security System Alarm Indicator ................ 75
SEL/RESET Button ....................................... 94
Select Lever ........................................ 16, 275
Operation ......................................... 16, 276
Releasing ................................................ 413
Won’t Move ........................................... 413
Selecting a Child Seat ................................. 54
Selector Knob (Audio) .............................. 190
Sequential Shift Mode ............................. 277
Setting the Clock ...................................... 118
Shift Lever ........................................... 16, 275
Shift Lever Position Indicator............. 68, 276
Shifting (Transmission) ............................. 275
Shoulder Anchor......................................... 33
Side Airbags ................................................ 44
Side Curtain Airbags................................... 46
SiriusXM® Radio ........................................ 200
SMS Text Message ............................ 236, 248
Snow Tires................................................. 378
Spare Tire .......................................... 391, 427
Spark Plugs................................................ 426
Specifications ............................................ 426
Specified Fuel.................................... 335, 426
Speedometer .............................................. 93
SRS Airbags (Airbags) ................................. 40
Starting the Engine .................................. 268
Does Not Start ......................................... 408
Jump Starting .......................................... 411
Remote Engine Start ................................ 270
Steering Wheel ......................................... 158
Adjusting................................................. 158
Stopping.................................................... 326
Summer Tires ............................................ 378
Sunglasses Holder ..................................... 176
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ........ 40
Switches
(Around the Steering Wheel) ........ 4, 5, 144
443
Index
444
Tire Repair Kit .......................................... 397
Wear Indicators ....................................... 375
Winter ..................................................... 378
Tools .......................................................... 390
Towing a Trailer........................................ 261
Equipment and Accessories...................... 262
Load Limits .............................................. 261
Towing Your Vehicle ................................ 265
Emergency............................................... 423
TPMS
(Tire Pressure Monitoring System)......... 310
Indicator ............................................ 73, 419
Transmission.............................................. 275
Automatic ............................................... 275
Fluid ........................................................ 356
Number ................................................... 428
Sequential Shift Mode ............................. 277
Shift Lever Position Indicator .............. 68, 276
Trip Meter ................................................... 98
Troubleshooting ....................................... 389
Blown Fuse ...................................... 420, 421
Brake Pedal Vibrates .................................. 20
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door .......... 21
Emergency Towing .................................. 423
Engine Won’t Start .................................. 408
Noise When Braking .................................. 22
Overheating............................................. 414
Puncture/Flat Tire............................. 391, 397
Rear Door Won’t Open ...................... 21, 129
Select Lever Won’t Move ......................... 413
Warning Indicators .................................... 66
Turn Signals .............................................. 147
Indicators (Instrument Panel) ..................... 73
Two-way Keyless Access
Remote.................................... 119, 127, 270
U
Unlocking the Doors ................................ 123
Unlocking the Front Doors
from the Inside ................................. 12, 128
USB Adapter Cable................................... 186
USB Flash Drives ....................................... 221
USB Port .................................................... 187
V
Vanity Mirrors............................................... 7
Vehicle Identification Number ................ 428
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA®).................. 305
Off Button............................................... 306
Off Indicator.............................................. 71
System Indicator................................ 71, 305
Viscosity (Oil) .................................... 349, 427
VSA® (Vehicle Stability Assist).................. 305
W
Wallpaper ................................................. 194
Warning and Information Messages......... 82
Warning Indicator On/Blinking ............... 416
Warning Labels........................................... 63
Warranties (Warranty Manual provided
separately) .............................................. 433
Watts ........................................................ 426
Wear Indicators (Tire) .............................. 375
Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle) ........... 394
Window Washers ..................................... 151
Adding/Refilling Fluid .............................. 358
Switch .................................................... 151
Windows (Opening and Closing) ............ 140
Windshield ............................................... 151
Cleaning ................................................. 386
Defrosting/Defogging ............................. 181
Washer Fluid........................................... 358
Wiper Blades........................................... 366
Wipers and Washers ............................... 151
Winter Tires.............................................. 378
Snow Tires .............................................. 378
Tire Chains.............................................. 378
Wipers and Washers ................................ 151
Automatic Intermittent Wipers ................ 152
Checking and Replacing Wiper Blades..... 366
Front....................................................... 151
Rear........................................................ 153
WMA................................................. 202, 210
Worn Tires ................................................ 370
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertisement